Makefile.in (stmp-docobjdir): New target; ensure $docobjdir exists.
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / expr.c
blobf95678f9dd12fa597d14e45cbc373f0f27bed429
1 /* Convert tree expression to rtl instructions, for GNU compiler.
2 Copyright (C) 1988, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999,
3 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GCC.
7 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
8 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
9 Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
10 version.
12 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
13 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
14 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
15 for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GCC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
19 Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA
20 02111-1307, USA. */
22 #include "config.h"
23 #include "system.h"
24 #include "coretypes.h"
25 #include "tm.h"
26 #include "machmode.h"
27 #include "real.h"
28 #include "rtl.h"
29 #include "tree.h"
30 #include "flags.h"
31 #include "regs.h"
32 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
33 #include "except.h"
34 #include "function.h"
35 #include "insn-config.h"
36 #include "insn-attr.h"
37 /* Include expr.h after insn-config.h so we get HAVE_conditional_move. */
38 #include "expr.h"
39 #include "optabs.h"
40 #include "libfuncs.h"
41 #include "recog.h"
42 #include "reload.h"
43 #include "output.h"
44 #include "typeclass.h"
45 #include "toplev.h"
46 #include "ggc.h"
47 #include "langhooks.h"
48 #include "intl.h"
49 #include "tm_p.h"
51 /* Decide whether a function's arguments should be processed
52 from first to last or from last to first.
54 They should if the stack and args grow in opposite directions, but
55 only if we have push insns. */
57 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
59 #ifndef PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
60 #if defined (STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD) != defined (ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD)
61 #define PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED /* If it's last to first. */
62 #endif
63 #endif
65 #endif
67 #ifndef STACK_PUSH_CODE
68 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
69 #define STACK_PUSH_CODE PRE_DEC
70 #else
71 #define STACK_PUSH_CODE PRE_INC
72 #endif
73 #endif
75 /* Assume that case vectors are not pc-relative. */
76 #ifndef CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
77 #define CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE 0
78 #endif
80 /* Convert defined/undefined to boolean. */
81 #ifdef TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
82 #undef TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
83 #define TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS 1
84 #else
85 #define TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS 0
86 #endif
89 /* If this is nonzero, we do not bother generating VOLATILE
90 around volatile memory references, and we are willing to
91 output indirect addresses. If cse is to follow, we reject
92 indirect addresses so a useful potential cse is generated;
93 if it is used only once, instruction combination will produce
94 the same indirect address eventually. */
95 int cse_not_expected;
97 /* Chain of pending expressions for PLACEHOLDER_EXPR to replace. */
98 tree placeholder_list = 0;
100 /* This structure is used by move_by_pieces to describe the move to
101 be performed. */
102 struct move_by_pieces
104 rtx to;
105 rtx to_addr;
106 int autinc_to;
107 int explicit_inc_to;
108 rtx from;
109 rtx from_addr;
110 int autinc_from;
111 int explicit_inc_from;
112 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len;
113 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
114 int reverse;
117 /* This structure is used by store_by_pieces to describe the clear to
118 be performed. */
120 struct store_by_pieces
122 rtx to;
123 rtx to_addr;
124 int autinc_to;
125 int explicit_inc_to;
126 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len;
127 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
128 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode);
129 void *constfundata;
130 int reverse;
133 static rtx enqueue_insn (rtx, rtx);
134 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT move_by_pieces_ninsns (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
135 unsigned int);
136 static void move_by_pieces_1 (rtx (*) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode,
137 struct move_by_pieces *);
138 static bool block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm (void);
139 static bool emit_block_move_via_movstr (rtx, rtx, rtx, unsigned);
140 static rtx emit_block_move_via_libcall (rtx, rtx, rtx);
141 static tree emit_block_move_libcall_fn (int);
142 static void emit_block_move_via_loop (rtx, rtx, rtx, unsigned);
143 static rtx clear_by_pieces_1 (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode);
144 static void clear_by_pieces (rtx, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
145 static void store_by_pieces_1 (struct store_by_pieces *, unsigned int);
146 static void store_by_pieces_2 (rtx (*) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode,
147 struct store_by_pieces *);
148 static bool clear_storage_via_clrstr (rtx, rtx, unsigned);
149 static rtx clear_storage_via_libcall (rtx, rtx);
150 static tree clear_storage_libcall_fn (int);
151 static rtx compress_float_constant (rtx, rtx);
152 static rtx get_subtarget (rtx);
153 static int is_zeros_p (tree);
154 static int mostly_zeros_p (tree);
155 static void store_constructor_field (rtx, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
156 HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode,
157 tree, tree, int, int);
158 static void store_constructor (tree, rtx, int, HOST_WIDE_INT);
159 static rtx store_field (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode,
160 tree, enum machine_mode, int, tree, int);
161 static rtx var_rtx (tree);
163 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT highest_pow2_factor (tree);
164 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT highest_pow2_factor_for_type (tree, tree);
166 static int is_aligning_offset (tree, tree);
167 static rtx expand_increment (tree, int, int);
168 static rtx do_store_flag (tree, rtx, enum machine_mode, int);
169 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
170 static void emit_single_push_insn (enum machine_mode, rtx, tree);
171 #endif
172 static void do_tablejump (rtx, enum machine_mode, rtx, rtx, rtx);
173 static rtx const_vector_from_tree (tree);
175 /* Record for each mode whether we can move a register directly to or
176 from an object of that mode in memory. If we can't, we won't try
177 to use that mode directly when accessing a field of that mode. */
179 static char direct_load[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
180 static char direct_store[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
182 /* Record for each mode whether we can float-extend from memory. */
184 static bool float_extend_from_mem[NUM_MACHINE_MODES][NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
186 /* If a memory-to-memory move would take MOVE_RATIO or more simple
187 move-instruction sequences, we will do a movstr or libcall instead. */
189 #ifndef MOVE_RATIO
190 #if defined (HAVE_movstrqi) || defined (HAVE_movstrhi) || defined (HAVE_movstrsi) || defined (HAVE_movstrdi) || defined (HAVE_movstrti)
191 #define MOVE_RATIO 2
192 #else
193 /* If we are optimizing for space (-Os), cut down the default move ratio. */
194 #define MOVE_RATIO (optimize_size ? 3 : 15)
195 #endif
196 #endif
198 /* This macro is used to determine whether move_by_pieces should be called
199 to perform a structure copy. */
200 #ifndef MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
201 #define MOVE_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
202 (move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN) < (unsigned int) MOVE_RATIO)
203 #endif
205 /* If a clear memory operation would take CLEAR_RATIO or more simple
206 move-instruction sequences, we will do a clrstr or libcall instead. */
208 #ifndef CLEAR_RATIO
209 #if defined (HAVE_clrstrqi) || defined (HAVE_clrstrhi) || defined (HAVE_clrstrsi) || defined (HAVE_clrstrdi) || defined (HAVE_clrstrti)
210 #define CLEAR_RATIO 2
211 #else
212 /* If we are optimizing for space, cut down the default clear ratio. */
213 #define CLEAR_RATIO (optimize_size ? 3 : 15)
214 #endif
215 #endif
217 /* This macro is used to determine whether clear_by_pieces should be
218 called to clear storage. */
219 #ifndef CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P
220 #define CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
221 (move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN) < (unsigned int) CLEAR_RATIO)
222 #endif
224 /* This macro is used to determine whether store_by_pieces should be
225 called to "memset" storage with byte values other than zero, or
226 to "memcpy" storage when the source is a constant string. */
227 #ifndef STORE_BY_PIECES_P
228 #define STORE_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (SIZE, ALIGN)
229 #endif
231 /* This array records the insn_code of insns to perform block moves. */
232 enum insn_code movstr_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
234 /* This array records the insn_code of insns to perform block clears. */
235 enum insn_code clrstr_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
237 /* SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS is nonzero if unaligned accesses are very slow. */
239 #ifndef SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
240 #define SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS(MODE, ALIGN) STRICT_ALIGNMENT
241 #endif
243 /* This is run once per compilation to set up which modes can be used
244 directly in memory and to initialize the block move optab. */
246 void
247 init_expr_once (void)
249 rtx insn, pat;
250 enum machine_mode mode;
251 int num_clobbers;
252 rtx mem, mem1;
253 rtx reg;
255 /* Try indexing by frame ptr and try by stack ptr.
256 It is known that on the Convex the stack ptr isn't a valid index.
257 With luck, one or the other is valid on any machine. */
258 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, stack_pointer_rtx);
259 mem1 = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, frame_pointer_rtx);
261 /* A scratch register we can modify in-place below to avoid
262 useless RTL allocations. */
263 reg = gen_rtx_REG (VOIDmode, -1);
265 insn = rtx_alloc (INSN);
266 pat = gen_rtx_SET (0, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
267 PATTERN (insn) = pat;
269 for (mode = VOIDmode; (int) mode < NUM_MACHINE_MODES;
270 mode = (enum machine_mode) ((int) mode + 1))
272 int regno;
274 direct_load[(int) mode] = direct_store[(int) mode] = 0;
275 PUT_MODE (mem, mode);
276 PUT_MODE (mem1, mode);
277 PUT_MODE (reg, mode);
279 /* See if there is some register that can be used in this mode and
280 directly loaded or stored from memory. */
282 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
283 for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
284 && (direct_load[(int) mode] == 0 || direct_store[(int) mode] == 0);
285 regno++)
287 if (! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, mode))
288 continue;
290 REGNO (reg) = regno;
292 SET_SRC (pat) = mem;
293 SET_DEST (pat) = reg;
294 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
295 direct_load[(int) mode] = 1;
297 SET_SRC (pat) = mem1;
298 SET_DEST (pat) = reg;
299 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
300 direct_load[(int) mode] = 1;
302 SET_SRC (pat) = reg;
303 SET_DEST (pat) = mem;
304 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
305 direct_store[(int) mode] = 1;
307 SET_SRC (pat) = reg;
308 SET_DEST (pat) = mem1;
309 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
310 direct_store[(int) mode] = 1;
314 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, gen_rtx_raw_REG (Pmode, 10000));
316 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_FLOAT); mode != VOIDmode;
317 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
319 enum machine_mode srcmode;
320 for (srcmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_FLOAT); srcmode != mode;
321 srcmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (srcmode))
323 enum insn_code ic;
325 ic = can_extend_p (mode, srcmode, 0);
326 if (ic == CODE_FOR_nothing)
327 continue;
329 PUT_MODE (mem, srcmode);
331 if ((*insn_data[ic].operand[1].predicate) (mem, srcmode))
332 float_extend_from_mem[mode][srcmode] = true;
337 /* This is run at the start of compiling a function. */
339 void
340 init_expr (void)
342 cfun->expr = ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct expr_status));
344 pending_chain = 0;
345 pending_stack_adjust = 0;
346 stack_pointer_delta = 0;
347 inhibit_defer_pop = 0;
348 saveregs_value = 0;
349 apply_args_value = 0;
350 forced_labels = 0;
353 /* Small sanity check that the queue is empty at the end of a function. */
355 void
356 finish_expr_for_function (void)
358 if (pending_chain)
359 abort ();
362 /* Manage the queue of increment instructions to be output
363 for POSTINCREMENT_EXPR expressions, etc. */
365 /* Queue up to increment (or change) VAR later. BODY says how:
366 BODY should be the same thing you would pass to emit_insn
367 to increment right away. It will go to emit_insn later on.
369 The value is a QUEUED expression to be used in place of VAR
370 where you want to guarantee the pre-incrementation value of VAR. */
372 static rtx
373 enqueue_insn (rtx var, rtx body)
375 pending_chain = gen_rtx_QUEUED (GET_MODE (var), var, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX,
376 body, pending_chain);
377 return pending_chain;
380 /* Use protect_from_queue to convert a QUEUED expression
381 into something that you can put immediately into an instruction.
382 If the queued incrementation has not happened yet,
383 protect_from_queue returns the variable itself.
384 If the incrementation has happened, protect_from_queue returns a temp
385 that contains a copy of the old value of the variable.
387 Any time an rtx which might possibly be a QUEUED is to be put
388 into an instruction, it must be passed through protect_from_queue first.
389 QUEUED expressions are not meaningful in instructions.
391 Do not pass a value through protect_from_queue and then hold
392 on to it for a while before putting it in an instruction!
393 If the queue is flushed in between, incorrect code will result. */
396 protect_from_queue (rtx x, int modify)
398 RTX_CODE code = GET_CODE (x);
400 #if 0 /* A QUEUED can hang around after the queue is forced out. */
401 /* Shortcut for most common case. */
402 if (pending_chain == 0)
403 return x;
404 #endif
406 if (code != QUEUED)
408 /* A special hack for read access to (MEM (QUEUED ...)) to facilitate
409 use of autoincrement. Make a copy of the contents of the memory
410 location rather than a copy of the address, but not if the value is
411 of mode BLKmode. Don't modify X in place since it might be
412 shared. */
413 if (code == MEM && GET_MODE (x) != BLKmode
414 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == QUEUED && !modify)
416 rtx y = XEXP (x, 0);
417 rtx new = replace_equiv_address_nv (x, QUEUED_VAR (y));
419 if (QUEUED_INSN (y))
421 rtx temp = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (x));
423 emit_insn_before (gen_move_insn (temp, new),
424 QUEUED_INSN (y));
425 return temp;
428 /* Copy the address into a pseudo, so that the returned value
429 remains correct across calls to emit_queue. */
430 return replace_equiv_address (new, copy_to_reg (XEXP (new, 0)));
433 /* Otherwise, recursively protect the subexpressions of all
434 the kinds of rtx's that can contain a QUEUED. */
435 if (code == MEM)
437 rtx tem = protect_from_queue (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
438 if (tem != XEXP (x, 0))
440 x = copy_rtx (x);
441 XEXP (x, 0) = tem;
444 else if (code == PLUS || code == MULT)
446 rtx new0 = protect_from_queue (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
447 rtx new1 = protect_from_queue (XEXP (x, 1), 0);
448 if (new0 != XEXP (x, 0) || new1 != XEXP (x, 1))
450 x = copy_rtx (x);
451 XEXP (x, 0) = new0;
452 XEXP (x, 1) = new1;
455 return x;
457 /* If the increment has not happened, use the variable itself. Copy it
458 into a new pseudo so that the value remains correct across calls to
459 emit_queue. */
460 if (QUEUED_INSN (x) == 0)
461 return copy_to_reg (QUEUED_VAR (x));
462 /* If the increment has happened and a pre-increment copy exists,
463 use that copy. */
464 if (QUEUED_COPY (x) != 0)
465 return QUEUED_COPY (x);
466 /* The increment has happened but we haven't set up a pre-increment copy.
467 Set one up now, and use it. */
468 QUEUED_COPY (x) = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (QUEUED_VAR (x)));
469 emit_insn_before (gen_move_insn (QUEUED_COPY (x), QUEUED_VAR (x)),
470 QUEUED_INSN (x));
471 return QUEUED_COPY (x);
474 /* Return nonzero if X contains a QUEUED expression:
475 if it contains anything that will be altered by a queued increment.
476 We handle only combinations of MEM, PLUS, MINUS and MULT operators
477 since memory addresses generally contain only those. */
480 queued_subexp_p (rtx x)
482 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
483 switch (code)
485 case QUEUED:
486 return 1;
487 case MEM:
488 return queued_subexp_p (XEXP (x, 0));
489 case MULT:
490 case PLUS:
491 case MINUS:
492 return (queued_subexp_p (XEXP (x, 0))
493 || queued_subexp_p (XEXP (x, 1)));
494 default:
495 return 0;
499 /* Perform all the pending incrementations. */
501 void
502 emit_queue (void)
504 rtx p;
505 while ((p = pending_chain))
507 rtx body = QUEUED_BODY (p);
509 switch (GET_CODE (body))
511 case INSN:
512 case JUMP_INSN:
513 case CALL_INSN:
514 case CODE_LABEL:
515 case BARRIER:
516 case NOTE:
517 QUEUED_INSN (p) = body;
518 emit_insn (body);
519 break;
521 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
522 case SEQUENCE:
523 abort ();
524 break;
525 #endif
527 default:
528 QUEUED_INSN (p) = emit_insn (body);
529 break;
532 pending_chain = QUEUED_NEXT (p);
536 /* Copy data from FROM to TO, where the machine modes are not the same.
537 Both modes may be integer, or both may be floating.
538 UNSIGNEDP should be nonzero if FROM is an unsigned type.
539 This causes zero-extension instead of sign-extension. */
541 void
542 convert_move (rtx to, rtx from, int unsignedp)
544 enum machine_mode to_mode = GET_MODE (to);
545 enum machine_mode from_mode = GET_MODE (from);
546 int to_real = GET_MODE_CLASS (to_mode) == MODE_FLOAT;
547 int from_real = GET_MODE_CLASS (from_mode) == MODE_FLOAT;
548 enum insn_code code;
549 rtx libcall;
551 /* rtx code for making an equivalent value. */
552 enum rtx_code equiv_code = (unsignedp < 0 ? UNKNOWN
553 : (unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND));
555 to = protect_from_queue (to, 1);
556 from = protect_from_queue (from, 0);
558 if (to_real != from_real)
559 abort ();
561 /* If FROM is a SUBREG that indicates that we have already done at least
562 the required extension, strip it. We don't handle such SUBREGs as
563 TO here. */
565 if (GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (from)
566 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (from)))
567 >= GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode))
568 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (from) == unsignedp)
569 from = gen_lowpart (to_mode, from), from_mode = to_mode;
571 if (GET_CODE (to) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (to))
572 abort ();
574 if (to_mode == from_mode
575 || (from_mode == VOIDmode && CONSTANT_P (from)))
577 emit_move_insn (to, from);
578 return;
581 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (to_mode) || VECTOR_MODE_P (from_mode))
583 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) != GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode))
584 abort ();
586 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (to_mode))
587 from = simplify_gen_subreg (to_mode, from, GET_MODE (from), 0);
588 else
589 to = simplify_gen_subreg (from_mode, to, GET_MODE (to), 0);
591 emit_move_insn (to, from);
592 return;
595 if (GET_CODE (to) == CONCAT && GET_CODE (from) == CONCAT)
597 convert_move (XEXP (to, 0), XEXP (from, 0), unsignedp);
598 convert_move (XEXP (to, 1), XEXP (from, 1), unsignedp);
599 return;
602 if (to_real != from_real)
603 abort ();
605 if (to_real)
607 rtx value, insns;
609 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode))
611 /* Try converting directly if the insn is supported. */
612 if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, 0))
613 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
615 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, UNKNOWN);
616 return;
620 #ifdef HAVE_trunchfqf2
621 if (HAVE_trunchfqf2 && from_mode == HFmode && to_mode == QFmode)
623 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunchfqf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
624 return;
626 #endif
627 #ifdef HAVE_trunctqfqf2
628 if (HAVE_trunctqfqf2 && from_mode == TQFmode && to_mode == QFmode)
630 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunctqfqf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
631 return;
633 #endif
634 #ifdef HAVE_truncsfqf2
635 if (HAVE_truncsfqf2 && from_mode == SFmode && to_mode == QFmode)
637 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncsfqf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
638 return;
640 #endif
641 #ifdef HAVE_truncdfqf2
642 if (HAVE_truncdfqf2 && from_mode == DFmode && to_mode == QFmode)
644 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncdfqf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
645 return;
647 #endif
648 #ifdef HAVE_truncxfqf2
649 if (HAVE_truncxfqf2 && from_mode == XFmode && to_mode == QFmode)
651 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncxfqf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
652 return;
654 #endif
655 #ifdef HAVE_trunctfqf2
656 if (HAVE_trunctfqf2 && from_mode == TFmode && to_mode == QFmode)
658 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunctfqf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
659 return;
661 #endif
663 #ifdef HAVE_trunctqfhf2
664 if (HAVE_trunctqfhf2 && from_mode == TQFmode && to_mode == HFmode)
666 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunctqfhf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
667 return;
669 #endif
670 #ifdef HAVE_truncsfhf2
671 if (HAVE_truncsfhf2 && from_mode == SFmode && to_mode == HFmode)
673 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncsfhf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
674 return;
676 #endif
677 #ifdef HAVE_truncdfhf2
678 if (HAVE_truncdfhf2 && from_mode == DFmode && to_mode == HFmode)
680 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncdfhf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
681 return;
683 #endif
684 #ifdef HAVE_truncxfhf2
685 if (HAVE_truncxfhf2 && from_mode == XFmode && to_mode == HFmode)
687 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncxfhf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
688 return;
690 #endif
691 #ifdef HAVE_trunctfhf2
692 if (HAVE_trunctfhf2 && from_mode == TFmode && to_mode == HFmode)
694 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunctfhf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
695 return;
697 #endif
699 #ifdef HAVE_truncsftqf2
700 if (HAVE_truncsftqf2 && from_mode == SFmode && to_mode == TQFmode)
702 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncsftqf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
703 return;
705 #endif
706 #ifdef HAVE_truncdftqf2
707 if (HAVE_truncdftqf2 && from_mode == DFmode && to_mode == TQFmode)
709 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncdftqf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
710 return;
712 #endif
713 #ifdef HAVE_truncxftqf2
714 if (HAVE_truncxftqf2 && from_mode == XFmode && to_mode == TQFmode)
716 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncxftqf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
717 return;
719 #endif
720 #ifdef HAVE_trunctftqf2
721 if (HAVE_trunctftqf2 && from_mode == TFmode && to_mode == TQFmode)
723 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunctftqf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
724 return;
726 #endif
728 #ifdef HAVE_truncdfsf2
729 if (HAVE_truncdfsf2 && from_mode == DFmode && to_mode == SFmode)
731 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncdfsf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
732 return;
734 #endif
735 #ifdef HAVE_truncxfsf2
736 if (HAVE_truncxfsf2 && from_mode == XFmode && to_mode == SFmode)
738 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncxfsf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
739 return;
741 #endif
742 #ifdef HAVE_trunctfsf2
743 if (HAVE_trunctfsf2 && from_mode == TFmode && to_mode == SFmode)
745 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunctfsf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
746 return;
748 #endif
749 #ifdef HAVE_truncxfdf2
750 if (HAVE_truncxfdf2 && from_mode == XFmode && to_mode == DFmode)
752 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncxfdf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
753 return;
755 #endif
756 #ifdef HAVE_trunctfdf2
757 if (HAVE_trunctfdf2 && from_mode == TFmode && to_mode == DFmode)
759 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunctfdf2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
760 return;
762 #endif
764 libcall = (rtx) 0;
765 switch (from_mode)
767 case SFmode:
768 switch (to_mode)
770 case DFmode:
771 libcall = extendsfdf2_libfunc;
772 break;
774 case XFmode:
775 libcall = extendsfxf2_libfunc;
776 break;
778 case TFmode:
779 libcall = extendsftf2_libfunc;
780 break;
782 default:
783 break;
785 break;
787 case DFmode:
788 switch (to_mode)
790 case SFmode:
791 libcall = truncdfsf2_libfunc;
792 break;
794 case XFmode:
795 libcall = extenddfxf2_libfunc;
796 break;
798 case TFmode:
799 libcall = extenddftf2_libfunc;
800 break;
802 default:
803 break;
805 break;
807 case XFmode:
808 switch (to_mode)
810 case SFmode:
811 libcall = truncxfsf2_libfunc;
812 break;
814 case DFmode:
815 libcall = truncxfdf2_libfunc;
816 break;
818 default:
819 break;
821 break;
823 case TFmode:
824 switch (to_mode)
826 case SFmode:
827 libcall = trunctfsf2_libfunc;
828 break;
830 case DFmode:
831 libcall = trunctfdf2_libfunc;
832 break;
834 default:
835 break;
837 break;
839 default:
840 break;
843 if (libcall == (rtx) 0)
844 /* This conversion is not implemented yet. */
845 abort ();
847 start_sequence ();
848 value = emit_library_call_value (libcall, NULL_RTX, LCT_CONST, to_mode,
849 1, from, from_mode);
850 insns = get_insns ();
851 end_sequence ();
852 emit_libcall_block (insns, to, value, gen_rtx_FLOAT_TRUNCATE (to_mode,
853 from));
854 return;
857 /* Now both modes are integers. */
859 /* Handle expanding beyond a word. */
860 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode)
861 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) > BITS_PER_WORD)
863 rtx insns;
864 rtx lowpart;
865 rtx fill_value;
866 rtx lowfrom;
867 int i;
868 enum machine_mode lowpart_mode;
869 int nwords = CEIL (GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode), UNITS_PER_WORD);
871 /* Try converting directly if the insn is supported. */
872 if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, unsignedp))
873 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
875 /* If FROM is a SUBREG, put it into a register. Do this
876 so that we always generate the same set of insns for
877 better cse'ing; if an intermediate assignment occurred,
878 we won't be doing the operation directly on the SUBREG. */
879 if (optimize > 0 && GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG)
880 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
881 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, equiv_code);
882 return;
884 /* Next, try converting via full word. */
885 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) < BITS_PER_WORD
886 && ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, word_mode, unsignedp))
887 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
889 if (GET_CODE (to) == REG)
890 emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, to));
891 convert_move (gen_lowpart (word_mode, to), from, unsignedp);
892 emit_unop_insn (code, to,
893 gen_lowpart (word_mode, to), equiv_code);
894 return;
897 /* No special multiword conversion insn; do it by hand. */
898 start_sequence ();
900 /* Since we will turn this into a no conflict block, we must ensure
901 that the source does not overlap the target. */
903 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (to, from))
904 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
906 /* Get a copy of FROM widened to a word, if necessary. */
907 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) < BITS_PER_WORD)
908 lowpart_mode = word_mode;
909 else
910 lowpart_mode = from_mode;
912 lowfrom = convert_to_mode (lowpart_mode, from, unsignedp);
914 lowpart = gen_lowpart (lowpart_mode, to);
915 emit_move_insn (lowpart, lowfrom);
917 /* Compute the value to put in each remaining word. */
918 if (unsignedp)
919 fill_value = const0_rtx;
920 else
922 #ifdef HAVE_slt
923 if (HAVE_slt
924 && insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_slt].operand[0].mode == word_mode
925 && STORE_FLAG_VALUE == -1)
927 emit_cmp_insn (lowfrom, const0_rtx, NE, NULL_RTX,
928 lowpart_mode, 0);
929 fill_value = gen_reg_rtx (word_mode);
930 emit_insn (gen_slt (fill_value));
932 else
933 #endif
935 fill_value
936 = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, lowpart_mode, lowfrom,
937 size_int (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (lowpart_mode) - 1),
938 NULL_RTX, 0);
939 fill_value = convert_to_mode (word_mode, fill_value, 1);
943 /* Fill the remaining words. */
944 for (i = GET_MODE_SIZE (lowpart_mode) / UNITS_PER_WORD; i < nwords; i++)
946 int index = (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN ? nwords - i - 1 : i);
947 rtx subword = operand_subword (to, index, 1, to_mode);
949 if (subword == 0)
950 abort ();
952 if (fill_value != subword)
953 emit_move_insn (subword, fill_value);
956 insns = get_insns ();
957 end_sequence ();
959 emit_no_conflict_block (insns, to, from, NULL_RTX,
960 gen_rtx_fmt_e (equiv_code, to_mode, copy_rtx (from)));
961 return;
964 /* Truncating multi-word to a word or less. */
965 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) > BITS_PER_WORD
966 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) <= BITS_PER_WORD)
968 if (!((GET_CODE (from) == MEM
969 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (from)
970 && direct_load[(int) to_mode]
971 && ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (from, 0)))
972 || GET_CODE (from) == REG
973 || GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG))
974 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
975 convert_move (to, gen_lowpart (word_mode, from), 0);
976 return;
979 /* Handle pointer conversion. */ /* SPEE 900220. */
980 if (to_mode == PQImode)
982 if (from_mode != QImode)
983 from = convert_to_mode (QImode, from, unsignedp);
985 #ifdef HAVE_truncqipqi2
986 if (HAVE_truncqipqi2)
988 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncqipqi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
989 return;
991 #endif /* HAVE_truncqipqi2 */
992 abort ();
995 if (from_mode == PQImode)
997 if (to_mode != QImode)
999 from = convert_to_mode (QImode, from, unsignedp);
1000 from_mode = QImode;
1002 else
1004 #ifdef HAVE_extendpqiqi2
1005 if (HAVE_extendpqiqi2)
1007 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_extendpqiqi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1008 return;
1010 #endif /* HAVE_extendpqiqi2 */
1011 abort ();
1015 if (to_mode == PSImode)
1017 if (from_mode != SImode)
1018 from = convert_to_mode (SImode, from, unsignedp);
1020 #ifdef HAVE_truncsipsi2
1021 if (HAVE_truncsipsi2)
1023 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncsipsi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1024 return;
1026 #endif /* HAVE_truncsipsi2 */
1027 abort ();
1030 if (from_mode == PSImode)
1032 if (to_mode != SImode)
1034 from = convert_to_mode (SImode, from, unsignedp);
1035 from_mode = SImode;
1037 else
1039 #ifdef HAVE_extendpsisi2
1040 if (! unsignedp && HAVE_extendpsisi2)
1042 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_extendpsisi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1043 return;
1045 #endif /* HAVE_extendpsisi2 */
1046 #ifdef HAVE_zero_extendpsisi2
1047 if (unsignedp && HAVE_zero_extendpsisi2)
1049 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_zero_extendpsisi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1050 return;
1052 #endif /* HAVE_zero_extendpsisi2 */
1053 abort ();
1057 if (to_mode == PDImode)
1059 if (from_mode != DImode)
1060 from = convert_to_mode (DImode, from, unsignedp);
1062 #ifdef HAVE_truncdipdi2
1063 if (HAVE_truncdipdi2)
1065 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncdipdi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1066 return;
1068 #endif /* HAVE_truncdipdi2 */
1069 abort ();
1072 if (from_mode == PDImode)
1074 if (to_mode != DImode)
1076 from = convert_to_mode (DImode, from, unsignedp);
1077 from_mode = DImode;
1079 else
1081 #ifdef HAVE_extendpdidi2
1082 if (HAVE_extendpdidi2)
1084 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_extendpdidi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1085 return;
1087 #endif /* HAVE_extendpdidi2 */
1088 abort ();
1092 /* Now follow all the conversions between integers
1093 no more than a word long. */
1095 /* For truncation, usually we can just refer to FROM in a narrower mode. */
1096 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode)
1097 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode),
1098 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode)))
1100 if (!((GET_CODE (from) == MEM
1101 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (from)
1102 && direct_load[(int) to_mode]
1103 && ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (from, 0)))
1104 || GET_CODE (from) == REG
1105 || GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG))
1106 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
1107 if (GET_CODE (from) == REG && REGNO (from) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1108 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (from), to_mode))
1109 from = copy_to_reg (from);
1110 emit_move_insn (to, gen_lowpart (to_mode, from));
1111 return;
1114 /* Handle extension. */
1115 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode))
1117 /* Convert directly if that works. */
1118 if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, unsignedp))
1119 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
1121 if (flag_force_mem)
1122 from = force_not_mem (from);
1124 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, equiv_code);
1125 return;
1127 else
1129 enum machine_mode intermediate;
1130 rtx tmp;
1131 tree shift_amount;
1133 /* Search for a mode to convert via. */
1134 for (intermediate = from_mode; intermediate != VOIDmode;
1135 intermediate = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (intermediate))
1136 if (((can_extend_p (to_mode, intermediate, unsignedp)
1137 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
1138 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (intermediate)
1139 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode),
1140 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (intermediate))))
1141 && (can_extend_p (intermediate, from_mode, unsignedp)
1142 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
1144 convert_move (to, convert_to_mode (intermediate, from,
1145 unsignedp), unsignedp);
1146 return;
1149 /* No suitable intermediate mode.
1150 Generate what we need with shifts. */
1151 shift_amount = build_int_2 (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode)
1152 - GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode), 0);
1153 from = gen_lowpart (to_mode, force_reg (from_mode, from));
1154 tmp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, to_mode, from, shift_amount,
1155 to, unsignedp);
1156 tmp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, to_mode, tmp, shift_amount,
1157 to, unsignedp);
1158 if (tmp != to)
1159 emit_move_insn (to, tmp);
1160 return;
1164 /* Support special truncate insns for certain modes. */
1166 if (from_mode == DImode && to_mode == SImode)
1168 #ifdef HAVE_truncdisi2
1169 if (HAVE_truncdisi2)
1171 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncdisi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1172 return;
1174 #endif
1175 convert_move (to, force_reg (from_mode, from), unsignedp);
1176 return;
1179 if (from_mode == DImode && to_mode == HImode)
1181 #ifdef HAVE_truncdihi2
1182 if (HAVE_truncdihi2)
1184 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncdihi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1185 return;
1187 #endif
1188 convert_move (to, force_reg (from_mode, from), unsignedp);
1189 return;
1192 if (from_mode == DImode && to_mode == QImode)
1194 #ifdef HAVE_truncdiqi2
1195 if (HAVE_truncdiqi2)
1197 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncdiqi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1198 return;
1200 #endif
1201 convert_move (to, force_reg (from_mode, from), unsignedp);
1202 return;
1205 if (from_mode == SImode && to_mode == HImode)
1207 #ifdef HAVE_truncsihi2
1208 if (HAVE_truncsihi2)
1210 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncsihi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1211 return;
1213 #endif
1214 convert_move (to, force_reg (from_mode, from), unsignedp);
1215 return;
1218 if (from_mode == SImode && to_mode == QImode)
1220 #ifdef HAVE_truncsiqi2
1221 if (HAVE_truncsiqi2)
1223 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_truncsiqi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1224 return;
1226 #endif
1227 convert_move (to, force_reg (from_mode, from), unsignedp);
1228 return;
1231 if (from_mode == HImode && to_mode == QImode)
1233 #ifdef HAVE_trunchiqi2
1234 if (HAVE_trunchiqi2)
1236 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunchiqi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1237 return;
1239 #endif
1240 convert_move (to, force_reg (from_mode, from), unsignedp);
1241 return;
1244 if (from_mode == TImode && to_mode == DImode)
1246 #ifdef HAVE_trunctidi2
1247 if (HAVE_trunctidi2)
1249 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunctidi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1250 return;
1252 #endif
1253 convert_move (to, force_reg (from_mode, from), unsignedp);
1254 return;
1257 if (from_mode == TImode && to_mode == SImode)
1259 #ifdef HAVE_trunctisi2
1260 if (HAVE_trunctisi2)
1262 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunctisi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1263 return;
1265 #endif
1266 convert_move (to, force_reg (from_mode, from), unsignedp);
1267 return;
1270 if (from_mode == TImode && to_mode == HImode)
1272 #ifdef HAVE_trunctihi2
1273 if (HAVE_trunctihi2)
1275 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunctihi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1276 return;
1278 #endif
1279 convert_move (to, force_reg (from_mode, from), unsignedp);
1280 return;
1283 if (from_mode == TImode && to_mode == QImode)
1285 #ifdef HAVE_trunctiqi2
1286 if (HAVE_trunctiqi2)
1288 emit_unop_insn (CODE_FOR_trunctiqi2, to, from, UNKNOWN);
1289 return;
1291 #endif
1292 convert_move (to, force_reg (from_mode, from), unsignedp);
1293 return;
1296 /* Handle truncation of volatile memrefs, and so on;
1297 the things that couldn't be truncated directly,
1298 and for which there was no special instruction. */
1299 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode))
1301 rtx temp = force_reg (to_mode, gen_lowpart (to_mode, from));
1302 emit_move_insn (to, temp);
1303 return;
1306 /* Mode combination is not recognized. */
1307 abort ();
1310 /* Return an rtx for a value that would result
1311 from converting X to mode MODE.
1312 Both X and MODE may be floating, or both integer.
1313 UNSIGNEDP is nonzero if X is an unsigned value.
1314 This can be done by referring to a part of X in place
1315 or by copying to a new temporary with conversion.
1317 This function *must not* call protect_from_queue
1318 except when putting X into an insn (in which case convert_move does it). */
1321 convert_to_mode (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, int unsignedp)
1323 return convert_modes (mode, VOIDmode, x, unsignedp);
1326 /* Return an rtx for a value that would result
1327 from converting X from mode OLDMODE to mode MODE.
1328 Both modes may be floating, or both integer.
1329 UNSIGNEDP is nonzero if X is an unsigned value.
1331 This can be done by referring to a part of X in place
1332 or by copying to a new temporary with conversion.
1334 You can give VOIDmode for OLDMODE, if you are sure X has a nonvoid mode.
1336 This function *must not* call protect_from_queue
1337 except when putting X into an insn (in which case convert_move does it). */
1340 convert_modes (enum machine_mode mode, enum machine_mode oldmode, rtx x, int unsignedp)
1342 rtx temp;
1344 /* If FROM is a SUBREG that indicates that we have already done at least
1345 the required extension, strip it. */
1347 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (x)
1348 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))) >= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
1349 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (x) == unsignedp)
1350 x = gen_lowpart (mode, x);
1352 if (GET_MODE (x) != VOIDmode)
1353 oldmode = GET_MODE (x);
1355 if (mode == oldmode)
1356 return x;
1358 /* There is one case that we must handle specially: If we are converting
1359 a CONST_INT into a mode whose size is twice HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT and
1360 we are to interpret the constant as unsigned, gen_lowpart will do
1361 the wrong if the constant appears negative. What we want to do is
1362 make the high-order word of the constant zero, not all ones. */
1364 if (unsignedp && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
1365 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
1366 && GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (x) < 0)
1368 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (x);
1370 if (oldmode != VOIDmode
1371 && HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode))
1373 int width = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode);
1375 /* We need to zero extend VAL. */
1376 val &= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << width) - 1;
1379 return immed_double_const (val, (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0, mode);
1382 /* We can do this with a gen_lowpart if both desired and current modes
1383 are integer, and this is either a constant integer, a register, or a
1384 non-volatile MEM. Except for the constant case where MODE is no
1385 wider than HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT, we must be narrowing the operand. */
1387 if ((GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT
1388 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
1389 || (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
1390 && GET_MODE_CLASS (oldmode) == MODE_INT
1391 && (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE
1392 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (oldmode)
1393 && ((GET_CODE (x) == MEM && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (x)
1394 && direct_load[(int) mode])
1395 || (GET_CODE (x) == REG
1396 && (! HARD_REGISTER_P (x)
1397 || HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (x), mode))
1398 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode),
1399 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)))))))))
1401 /* ?? If we don't know OLDMODE, we have to assume here that
1402 X does not need sign- or zero-extension. This may not be
1403 the case, but it's the best we can do. */
1404 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT && oldmode != VOIDmode
1405 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > GET_MODE_SIZE (oldmode))
1407 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (x);
1408 int width = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode);
1410 /* We must sign or zero-extend in this case. Start by
1411 zero-extending, then sign extend if we need to. */
1412 val &= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << width) - 1;
1413 if (! unsignedp
1414 && (val & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (width - 1))))
1415 val |= (HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1) << width;
1417 return gen_int_mode (val, mode);
1420 return gen_lowpart (mode, x);
1423 temp = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
1424 convert_move (temp, x, unsignedp);
1425 return temp;
1428 /* STORE_MAX_PIECES is the number of bytes at a time that we can
1429 store efficiently. Due to internal GCC limitations, this is
1430 MOVE_MAX_PIECES limited by the number of bytes GCC can represent
1431 for an immediate constant. */
1433 #define STORE_MAX_PIECES MIN (MOVE_MAX_PIECES, 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
1435 /* Determine whether the LEN bytes can be moved by using several move
1436 instructions. Return nonzero if a call to move_by_pieces should
1437 succeed. */
1440 can_move_by_pieces (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
1441 unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1443 return MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (len, align);
1446 /* Generate several move instructions to copy LEN bytes from block FROM to
1447 block TO. (These are MEM rtx's with BLKmode). The caller must pass FROM
1448 and TO through protect_from_queue before calling.
1450 If PUSH_ROUNDING is defined and TO is NULL, emit_single_push_insn is
1451 used to push FROM to the stack.
1453 ALIGN is maximum stack alignment we can assume.
1455 If ENDP is 0 return to, if ENDP is 1 return memory at the end ala
1456 mempcpy, and if ENDP is 2 return memory the end minus one byte ala
1457 stpcpy. */
1460 move_by_pieces (rtx to, rtx from, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
1461 unsigned int align, int endp)
1463 struct move_by_pieces data;
1464 rtx to_addr, from_addr = XEXP (from, 0);
1465 unsigned int max_size = MOVE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
1466 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode, tmode;
1467 enum insn_code icode;
1469 align = MIN (to ? MEM_ALIGN (to) : align, MEM_ALIGN (from));
1471 data.offset = 0;
1472 data.from_addr = from_addr;
1473 if (to)
1475 to_addr = XEXP (to, 0);
1476 data.to = to;
1477 data.autinc_to
1478 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC
1479 || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
1480 data.reverse
1481 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
1483 else
1485 to_addr = NULL_RTX;
1486 data.to = NULL_RTX;
1487 data.autinc_to = 1;
1488 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1489 data.reverse = 1;
1490 #else
1491 data.reverse = 0;
1492 #endif
1494 data.to_addr = to_addr;
1495 data.from = from;
1496 data.autinc_from
1497 = (GET_CODE (from_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (from_addr) == PRE_DEC
1498 || GET_CODE (from_addr) == POST_INC
1499 || GET_CODE (from_addr) == POST_DEC);
1501 data.explicit_inc_from = 0;
1502 data.explicit_inc_to = 0;
1503 if (data.reverse) data.offset = len;
1504 data.len = len;
1506 /* If copying requires more than two move insns,
1507 copy addresses to registers (to make displacements shorter)
1508 and use post-increment if available. */
1509 if (!(data.autinc_from && data.autinc_to)
1510 && move_by_pieces_ninsns (len, align) > 2)
1512 /* Find the mode of the largest move... */
1513 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
1514 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
1515 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
1516 mode = tmode;
1518 if (USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data.reverse && ! data.autinc_from)
1520 data.from_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (from_addr, len));
1521 data.autinc_from = 1;
1522 data.explicit_inc_from = -1;
1524 if (USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data.autinc_from)
1526 data.from_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (from_addr);
1527 data.autinc_from = 1;
1528 data.explicit_inc_from = 1;
1530 if (!data.autinc_from && CONSTANT_P (from_addr))
1531 data.from_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (from_addr);
1532 if (USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data.reverse && ! data.autinc_to)
1534 data.to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (to_addr, len));
1535 data.autinc_to = 1;
1536 data.explicit_inc_to = -1;
1538 if (USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data.reverse && ! data.autinc_to)
1540 data.to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (to_addr);
1541 data.autinc_to = 1;
1542 data.explicit_inc_to = 1;
1544 if (!data.autinc_to && CONSTANT_P (to_addr))
1545 data.to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (to_addr);
1548 if (! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (word_mode, align)
1549 || align > MOVE_MAX * BITS_PER_UNIT || align >= BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT)
1550 align = MOVE_MAX * BITS_PER_UNIT;
1552 /* First move what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
1553 successively smaller modes. */
1555 while (max_size > 1)
1557 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
1558 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
1559 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
1560 mode = tmode;
1562 if (mode == VOIDmode)
1563 break;
1565 icode = mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code;
1566 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
1567 move_by_pieces_1 (GEN_FCN (icode), mode, &data);
1569 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1572 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
1573 if (data.len > 0)
1574 abort ();
1576 if (endp)
1578 rtx to1;
1580 if (data.reverse)
1581 abort ();
1582 if (data.autinc_to)
1584 if (endp == 2)
1586 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data.explicit_inc_to > 0)
1587 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data.to_addr, constm1_rtx));
1588 else
1589 data.to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (data.to_addr,
1590 -1));
1592 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data.to, QImode, data.to_addr,
1593 data.offset);
1595 else
1597 if (endp == 2)
1598 --data.offset;
1599 to1 = adjust_address (data.to, QImode, data.offset);
1601 return to1;
1603 else
1604 return data.to;
1607 /* Return number of insns required to move L bytes by pieces.
1608 ALIGN (in bits) is maximum alignment we can assume. */
1610 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
1611 move_by_pieces_ninsns (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT l, unsigned int align)
1613 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n_insns = 0;
1614 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_size = MOVE_MAX + 1;
1616 if (! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (word_mode, align)
1617 || align > MOVE_MAX * BITS_PER_UNIT || align >= BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT)
1618 align = MOVE_MAX * BITS_PER_UNIT;
1620 while (max_size > 1)
1622 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode, tmode;
1623 enum insn_code icode;
1625 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
1626 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
1627 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
1628 mode = tmode;
1630 if (mode == VOIDmode)
1631 break;
1633 icode = mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code;
1634 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
1635 n_insns += l / GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), l %= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1637 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1640 if (l)
1641 abort ();
1642 return n_insns;
1645 /* Subroutine of move_by_pieces. Move as many bytes as appropriate
1646 with move instructions for mode MODE. GENFUN is the gen_... function
1647 to make a move insn for that mode. DATA has all the other info. */
1649 static void
1650 move_by_pieces_1 (rtx (*genfun) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode mode,
1651 struct move_by_pieces *data)
1653 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1654 rtx to1 = NULL_RTX, from1;
1656 while (data->len >= size)
1658 if (data->reverse)
1659 data->offset -= size;
1661 if (data->to)
1663 if (data->autinc_to)
1664 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->to, mode, data->to_addr,
1665 data->offset);
1666 else
1667 to1 = adjust_address (data->to, mode, data->offset);
1670 if (data->autinc_from)
1671 from1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->from, mode, data->from_addr,
1672 data->offset);
1673 else
1674 from1 = adjust_address (data->from, mode, data->offset);
1676 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to < 0)
1677 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr,
1678 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT)size)));
1679 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_from < 0)
1680 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->from_addr,
1681 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT)size)));
1683 if (data->to)
1684 emit_insn ((*genfun) (to1, from1));
1685 else
1687 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
1688 emit_single_push_insn (mode, from1, NULL);
1689 #else
1690 abort ();
1691 #endif
1694 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to > 0)
1695 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
1696 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_from > 0)
1697 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->from_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
1699 if (! data->reverse)
1700 data->offset += size;
1702 data->len -= size;
1706 /* Emit code to move a block Y to a block X. This may be done with
1707 string-move instructions, with multiple scalar move instructions,
1708 or with a library call.
1710 Both X and Y must be MEM rtx's (perhaps inside VOLATILE) with mode BLKmode.
1711 SIZE is an rtx that says how long they are.
1712 ALIGN is the maximum alignment we can assume they have.
1713 METHOD describes what kind of copy this is, and what mechanisms may be used.
1715 Return the address of the new block, if memcpy is called and returns it,
1716 0 otherwise. */
1719 emit_block_move (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method)
1721 bool may_use_call;
1722 rtx retval = 0;
1723 unsigned int align;
1725 switch (method)
1727 case BLOCK_OP_NORMAL:
1728 may_use_call = true;
1729 break;
1731 case BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM:
1732 may_use_call = block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm ();
1734 /* Make inhibit_defer_pop nonzero around the library call
1735 to force it to pop the arguments right away. */
1736 NO_DEFER_POP;
1737 break;
1739 case BLOCK_OP_NO_LIBCALL:
1740 may_use_call = false;
1741 break;
1743 default:
1744 abort ();
1747 align = MIN (MEM_ALIGN (x), MEM_ALIGN (y));
1749 if (GET_MODE (x) != BLKmode)
1750 abort ();
1751 if (GET_MODE (y) != BLKmode)
1752 abort ();
1754 x = protect_from_queue (x, 1);
1755 y = protect_from_queue (y, 0);
1756 size = protect_from_queue (size, 0);
1758 if (GET_CODE (x) != MEM)
1759 abort ();
1760 if (GET_CODE (y) != MEM)
1761 abort ();
1762 if (size == 0)
1763 abort ();
1765 /* Set MEM_SIZE as appropriate for this block copy. The main place this
1766 can be incorrect is coming from __builtin_memcpy. */
1767 if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT)
1769 if (INTVAL (size) == 0)
1770 return 0;
1772 x = shallow_copy_rtx (x);
1773 y = shallow_copy_rtx (y);
1774 set_mem_size (x, size);
1775 set_mem_size (y, size);
1778 if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT && MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (INTVAL (size), align))
1779 move_by_pieces (x, y, INTVAL (size), align, 0);
1780 else if (emit_block_move_via_movstr (x, y, size, align))
1782 else if (may_use_call)
1783 retval = emit_block_move_via_libcall (x, y, size);
1784 else
1785 emit_block_move_via_loop (x, y, size, align);
1787 if (method == BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM)
1788 OK_DEFER_POP;
1790 return retval;
1793 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Returns true if calling the
1794 block move libcall will not clobber any parameters which may have
1795 already been placed on the stack. */
1797 static bool
1798 block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm (void)
1800 if (PUSH_ARGS)
1801 return true;
1802 else
1804 /* Check to see whether memcpy takes all register arguments. */
1805 static enum {
1806 takes_regs_uninit, takes_regs_no, takes_regs_yes
1807 } takes_regs = takes_regs_uninit;
1809 switch (takes_regs)
1811 case takes_regs_uninit:
1813 CUMULATIVE_ARGS args_so_far;
1814 tree fn, arg;
1816 fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (false);
1817 INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (args_so_far, TREE_TYPE (fn), NULL_RTX, 0);
1819 arg = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (fn));
1820 for ( ; arg != void_list_node ; arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg))
1822 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_VALUE (arg));
1823 rtx tmp = FUNCTION_ARG (args_so_far, mode, NULL_TREE, 1);
1824 if (!tmp || !REG_P (tmp))
1825 goto fail_takes_regs;
1826 #ifdef FUNCTION_ARG_PARTIAL_NREGS
1827 if (FUNCTION_ARG_PARTIAL_NREGS (args_so_far, mode,
1828 NULL_TREE, 1))
1829 goto fail_takes_regs;
1830 #endif
1831 FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (args_so_far, mode, NULL_TREE, 1);
1834 takes_regs = takes_regs_yes;
1835 /* FALLTHRU */
1837 case takes_regs_yes:
1838 return true;
1840 fail_takes_regs:
1841 takes_regs = takes_regs_no;
1842 /* FALLTHRU */
1843 case takes_regs_no:
1844 return false;
1846 default:
1847 abort ();
1852 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Expand a movstr pattern;
1853 return true if successful. */
1855 static bool
1856 emit_block_move_via_movstr (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, unsigned int align)
1858 rtx opalign = GEN_INT (align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
1859 enum machine_mode mode;
1861 /* Since this is a move insn, we don't care about volatility. */
1862 volatile_ok = 1;
1864 /* Try the most limited insn first, because there's no point
1865 including more than one in the machine description unless
1866 the more limited one has some advantage. */
1868 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT); mode != VOIDmode;
1869 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
1871 enum insn_code code = movstr_optab[(int) mode];
1872 insn_operand_predicate_fn pred;
1874 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
1875 /* We don't need MODE to be narrower than BITS_PER_HOST_WIDE_INT
1876 here because if SIZE is less than the mode mask, as it is
1877 returned by the macro, it will definitely be less than the
1878 actual mode mask. */
1879 && ((GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
1880 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
1881 <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
1882 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= BITS_PER_WORD)
1883 && ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[0].predicate) == 0
1884 || (*pred) (x, BLKmode))
1885 && ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[1].predicate) == 0
1886 || (*pred) (y, BLKmode))
1887 && ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[3].predicate) == 0
1888 || (*pred) (opalign, VOIDmode)))
1890 rtx op2;
1891 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
1892 rtx pat;
1894 op2 = convert_to_mode (mode, size, 1);
1895 pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[2].predicate;
1896 if (pred != 0 && ! (*pred) (op2, mode))
1897 op2 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, op2);
1899 /* ??? When called via emit_block_move_for_call, it'd be
1900 nice if there were some way to inform the backend, so
1901 that it doesn't fail the expansion because it thinks
1902 emitting the libcall would be more efficient. */
1904 pat = GEN_FCN ((int) code) (x, y, op2, opalign);
1905 if (pat)
1907 emit_insn (pat);
1908 volatile_ok = 0;
1909 return true;
1911 else
1912 delete_insns_since (last);
1916 volatile_ok = 0;
1917 return false;
1920 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Expand a call to memcpy or bcopy.
1921 Return the return value from memcpy, 0 otherwise. */
1923 static rtx
1924 emit_block_move_via_libcall (rtx dst, rtx src, rtx size)
1926 rtx dst_addr, src_addr;
1927 tree call_expr, arg_list, fn, src_tree, dst_tree, size_tree;
1928 enum machine_mode size_mode;
1929 rtx retval;
1931 /* DST, SRC, or SIZE may have been passed through protect_from_queue.
1933 It is unsafe to save the value generated by protect_from_queue and reuse
1934 it later. Consider what happens if emit_queue is called before the
1935 return value from protect_from_queue is used.
1937 Expansion of the CALL_EXPR below will call emit_queue before we are
1938 finished emitting RTL for argument setup. So if we are not careful we
1939 could get the wrong value for an argument.
1941 To avoid this problem we go ahead and emit code to copy the addresses of
1942 DST and SRC and SIZE into new pseudos. We can then place those new
1943 pseudos into an RTL_EXPR and use them later, even after a call to
1944 emit_queue.
1946 Note this is not strictly needed for library calls since they do not call
1947 emit_queue before loading their arguments. However, we may need to have
1948 library calls call emit_queue in the future since failing to do so could
1949 cause problems for targets which define SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES and pass
1950 arguments in registers. */
1952 dst_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, XEXP (dst, 0));
1953 src_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, XEXP (src, 0));
1955 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
1956 dst_addr = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, dst_addr);
1957 src_addr = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, src_addr);
1958 #endif
1960 dst_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, dst_addr);
1961 src_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, src_addr);
1963 if (TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS)
1964 size_mode = TYPE_MODE (sizetype);
1965 else
1966 size_mode = TYPE_MODE (unsigned_type_node);
1968 size = convert_to_mode (size_mode, size, 1);
1969 size = copy_to_mode_reg (size_mode, size);
1971 /* It is incorrect to use the libcall calling conventions to call
1972 memcpy in this context. This could be a user call to memcpy and
1973 the user may wish to examine the return value from memcpy. For
1974 targets where libcalls and normal calls have different conventions
1975 for returning pointers, we could end up generating incorrect code.
1977 For convenience, we generate the call to bcopy this way as well. */
1979 if (TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS)
1980 size_tree = make_tree (sizetype, size);
1981 else
1982 size_tree = make_tree (unsigned_type_node, size);
1984 fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (true);
1985 arg_list = tree_cons (NULL_TREE, size_tree, NULL_TREE);
1986 if (TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS)
1988 arg_list = tree_cons (NULL_TREE, src_tree, arg_list);
1989 arg_list = tree_cons (NULL_TREE, dst_tree, arg_list);
1991 else
1993 arg_list = tree_cons (NULL_TREE, dst_tree, arg_list);
1994 arg_list = tree_cons (NULL_TREE, src_tree, arg_list);
1997 /* Now we have to build up the CALL_EXPR itself. */
1998 call_expr = build1 (ADDR_EXPR, build_pointer_type (TREE_TYPE (fn)), fn);
1999 call_expr = build (CALL_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (fn)),
2000 call_expr, arg_list, NULL_TREE);
2001 TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (call_expr) = 1;
2003 retval = expand_expr (call_expr, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
2005 /* If we are initializing a readonly value, show the above call clobbered
2006 it. Otherwise, a load from it may erroneously be hoisted from a loop, or
2007 the delay slot scheduler might overlook conflicts and take nasty
2008 decisions. */
2009 if (RTX_UNCHANGING_P (dst))
2010 add_function_usage_to
2011 (last_call_insn (), gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode,
2012 gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, dst),
2013 NULL_RTX));
2015 return TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS ? retval : NULL_RTX;
2018 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move_via_libcall. Create the tree node
2019 for the function we use for block copies. The first time FOR_CALL
2020 is true, we call assemble_external. */
2022 static GTY(()) tree block_move_fn;
2024 void
2025 init_block_move_fn (const char *asmspec)
2027 if (!block_move_fn)
2029 tree args, fn;
2031 if (TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS)
2033 fn = get_identifier ("memcpy");
2034 args = build_function_type_list (ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node,
2035 const_ptr_type_node, sizetype,
2036 NULL_TREE);
2038 else
2040 fn = get_identifier ("bcopy");
2041 args = build_function_type_list (void_type_node, const_ptr_type_node,
2042 ptr_type_node, unsigned_type_node,
2043 NULL_TREE);
2046 fn = build_decl (FUNCTION_DECL, fn, args);
2047 DECL_EXTERNAL (fn) = 1;
2048 TREE_PUBLIC (fn) = 1;
2049 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (fn) = 1;
2050 TREE_NOTHROW (fn) = 1;
2052 block_move_fn = fn;
2055 if (asmspec)
2057 SET_DECL_RTL (block_move_fn, NULL_RTX);
2058 SET_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (block_move_fn, get_identifier (asmspec));
2062 static tree
2063 emit_block_move_libcall_fn (int for_call)
2065 static bool emitted_extern;
2067 if (!block_move_fn)
2068 init_block_move_fn (NULL);
2070 if (for_call && !emitted_extern)
2072 emitted_extern = true;
2073 make_decl_rtl (block_move_fn, NULL);
2074 assemble_external (block_move_fn);
2077 return block_move_fn;
2080 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Copy the data via an explicit
2081 loop. This is used only when libcalls are forbidden. */
2082 /* ??? It'd be nice to copy in hunks larger than QImode. */
2084 static void
2085 emit_block_move_via_loop (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size,
2086 unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2088 rtx cmp_label, top_label, iter, x_addr, y_addr, tmp;
2089 enum machine_mode iter_mode;
2091 iter_mode = GET_MODE (size);
2092 if (iter_mode == VOIDmode)
2093 iter_mode = word_mode;
2095 top_label = gen_label_rtx ();
2096 cmp_label = gen_label_rtx ();
2097 iter = gen_reg_rtx (iter_mode);
2099 emit_move_insn (iter, const0_rtx);
2101 x_addr = force_operand (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX);
2102 y_addr = force_operand (XEXP (y, 0), NULL_RTX);
2103 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
2105 emit_note (NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG);
2107 emit_jump (cmp_label);
2108 emit_label (top_label);
2110 tmp = convert_modes (Pmode, iter_mode, iter, true);
2111 x_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, x_addr, tmp);
2112 y_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, y_addr, tmp);
2113 x = change_address (x, QImode, x_addr);
2114 y = change_address (y, QImode, y_addr);
2116 emit_move_insn (x, y);
2118 tmp = expand_simple_binop (iter_mode, PLUS, iter, const1_rtx, iter,
2119 true, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
2120 if (tmp != iter)
2121 emit_move_insn (iter, tmp);
2123 emit_note (NOTE_INSN_LOOP_CONT);
2124 emit_label (cmp_label);
2126 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (iter, size, LT, NULL_RTX, iter_mode,
2127 true, top_label);
2129 emit_note (NOTE_INSN_LOOP_END);
2132 /* Copy all or part of a value X into registers starting at REGNO.
2133 The number of registers to be filled is NREGS. */
2135 void
2136 move_block_to_reg (int regno, rtx x, int nregs, enum machine_mode mode)
2138 int i;
2139 #ifdef HAVE_load_multiple
2140 rtx pat;
2141 rtx last;
2142 #endif
2144 if (nregs == 0)
2145 return;
2147 if (CONSTANT_P (x) && ! LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (x))
2148 x = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, x));
2150 /* See if the machine can do this with a load multiple insn. */
2151 #ifdef HAVE_load_multiple
2152 if (HAVE_load_multiple)
2154 last = get_last_insn ();
2155 pat = gen_load_multiple (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno), x,
2156 GEN_INT (nregs));
2157 if (pat)
2159 emit_insn (pat);
2160 return;
2162 else
2163 delete_insns_since (last);
2165 #endif
2167 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
2168 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno + i),
2169 operand_subword_force (x, i, mode));
2172 /* Copy all or part of a BLKmode value X out of registers starting at REGNO.
2173 The number of registers to be filled is NREGS. */
2175 void
2176 move_block_from_reg (int regno, rtx x, int nregs)
2178 int i;
2180 if (nregs == 0)
2181 return;
2183 /* See if the machine can do this with a store multiple insn. */
2184 #ifdef HAVE_store_multiple
2185 if (HAVE_store_multiple)
2187 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
2188 rtx pat = gen_store_multiple (x, gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno),
2189 GEN_INT (nregs));
2190 if (pat)
2192 emit_insn (pat);
2193 return;
2195 else
2196 delete_insns_since (last);
2198 #endif
2200 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
2202 rtx tem = operand_subword (x, i, 1, BLKmode);
2204 if (tem == 0)
2205 abort ();
2207 emit_move_insn (tem, gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno + i));
2211 /* Generate a PARALLEL rtx for a new non-consecutive group of registers from
2212 ORIG, where ORIG is a non-consecutive group of registers represented by
2213 a PARALLEL. The clone is identical to the original except in that the
2214 original set of registers is replaced by a new set of pseudo registers.
2215 The new set has the same modes as the original set. */
2218 gen_group_rtx (rtx orig)
2220 int i, length;
2221 rtx *tmps;
2223 if (GET_CODE (orig) != PARALLEL)
2224 abort ();
2226 length = XVECLEN (orig, 0);
2227 tmps = alloca (sizeof (rtx) * length);
2229 /* Skip a NULL entry in first slot. */
2230 i = XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, 0), 0) ? 0 : 1;
2232 if (i)
2233 tmps[0] = 0;
2235 for (; i < length; i++)
2237 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, i), 0));
2238 rtx offset = XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, i), 1);
2240 tmps[i] = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, gen_reg_rtx (mode), offset);
2243 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (orig), gen_rtvec_v (length, tmps));
2246 /* Emit code to move a block ORIG_SRC of type TYPE to a block DST,
2247 where DST is non-consecutive registers represented by a PARALLEL.
2248 SSIZE represents the total size of block ORIG_SRC in bytes, or -1
2249 if not known. */
2251 void
2252 emit_group_load (rtx dst, rtx orig_src, tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int ssize)
2254 rtx *tmps, src;
2255 int start, i;
2257 if (GET_CODE (dst) != PARALLEL)
2258 abort ();
2260 /* Check for a NULL entry, used to indicate that the parameter goes
2261 both on the stack and in registers. */
2262 if (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, 0), 0))
2263 start = 0;
2264 else
2265 start = 1;
2267 tmps = alloca (sizeof (rtx) * XVECLEN (dst, 0));
2269 /* Process the pieces. */
2270 for (i = start; i < XVECLEN (dst, 0); i++)
2272 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0));
2273 HOST_WIDE_INT bytepos = INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 1));
2274 unsigned int bytelen = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2275 int shift = 0;
2277 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct. */
2278 if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen > ssize)
2280 /* Arrange to shift the fragment to where it belongs.
2281 extract_bit_field loads to the lsb of the reg. */
2282 if (
2283 #ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
2284 BLOCK_REG_PADDING (GET_MODE (orig_src), type, i == start)
2285 == (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? upward : downward)
2286 #else
2287 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2288 #endif
2290 shift = (bytelen - (ssize - bytepos)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2291 bytelen = ssize - bytepos;
2292 if (bytelen <= 0)
2293 abort ();
2296 /* If we won't be loading directly from memory, protect the real source
2297 from strange tricks we might play; but make sure that the source can
2298 be loaded directly into the destination. */
2299 src = orig_src;
2300 if (GET_CODE (orig_src) != MEM
2301 && (!CONSTANT_P (orig_src)
2302 || (GET_MODE (orig_src) != mode
2303 && GET_MODE (orig_src) != VOIDmode)))
2305 if (GET_MODE (orig_src) == VOIDmode)
2306 src = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
2307 else
2308 src = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (orig_src));
2310 emit_move_insn (src, orig_src);
2313 /* Optimize the access just a bit. */
2314 if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM
2315 && (! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (src))
2316 || MEM_ALIGN (src) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2317 && bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) == 0
2318 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
2320 tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
2321 emit_move_insn (tmps[i], adjust_address (src, mode, bytepos));
2323 else if (GET_CODE (src) == CONCAT)
2325 unsigned int slen = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src));
2326 unsigned int slen0 = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (src, 0)));
2328 if ((bytepos == 0 && bytelen == slen0)
2329 || (bytepos != 0 && bytepos + bytelen <= slen))
2331 /* The following assumes that the concatenated objects all
2332 have the same size. In this case, a simple calculation
2333 can be used to determine the object and the bit field
2334 to be extracted. */
2335 tmps[i] = XEXP (src, bytepos / slen0);
2336 if (! CONSTANT_P (tmps[i])
2337 && (GET_CODE (tmps[i]) != REG || GET_MODE (tmps[i]) != mode))
2338 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (tmps[i], bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2339 (bytepos % slen0) * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2340 1, NULL_RTX, mode, mode, ssize);
2342 else if (bytepos == 0)
2344 rtx mem = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (src), slen, 0);
2345 emit_move_insn (mem, src);
2346 tmps[i] = adjust_address (mem, mode, 0);
2348 else
2349 abort ();
2351 /* FIXME: A SIMD parallel will eventually lead to a subreg of a
2352 SIMD register, which is currently broken. While we get GCC
2353 to emit proper RTL for these cases, let's dump to memory. */
2354 else if (VECTOR_MODE_P (GET_MODE (dst))
2355 && GET_CODE (src) == REG)
2357 int slen = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src));
2358 rtx mem;
2360 mem = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (src), slen, 0);
2361 emit_move_insn (mem, src);
2362 tmps[i] = adjust_address (mem, mode, (int) bytepos);
2364 else if (CONSTANT_P (src)
2365 || (GET_CODE (src) == REG && GET_MODE (src) == mode))
2366 tmps[i] = src;
2367 else
2368 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (src, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2369 bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT, 1, NULL_RTX,
2370 mode, mode, ssize);
2372 if (shift)
2373 expand_binop (mode, ashl_optab, tmps[i], GEN_INT (shift),
2374 tmps[i], 0, OPTAB_WIDEN);
2377 emit_queue ();
2379 /* Copy the extracted pieces into the proper (probable) hard regs. */
2380 for (i = start; i < XVECLEN (dst, 0); i++)
2381 emit_move_insn (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0), tmps[i]);
2384 /* Emit code to move a block SRC to block DST, where SRC and DST are
2385 non-consecutive groups of registers, each represented by a PARALLEL. */
2387 void
2388 emit_group_move (rtx dst, rtx src)
2390 int i;
2392 if (GET_CODE (src) != PARALLEL
2393 || GET_CODE (dst) != PARALLEL
2394 || XVECLEN (src, 0) != XVECLEN (dst, 0))
2395 abort ();
2397 /* Skip first entry if NULL. */
2398 for (i = XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0), 0) ? 0 : 1; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
2399 emit_move_insn (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0),
2400 XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 0));
2403 /* Emit code to move a block SRC to a block ORIG_DST of type TYPE,
2404 where SRC is non-consecutive registers represented by a PARALLEL.
2405 SSIZE represents the total size of block ORIG_DST, or -1 if not
2406 known. */
2408 void
2409 emit_group_store (rtx orig_dst, rtx src, tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int ssize)
2411 rtx *tmps, dst;
2412 int start, i;
2414 if (GET_CODE (src) != PARALLEL)
2415 abort ();
2417 /* Check for a NULL entry, used to indicate that the parameter goes
2418 both on the stack and in registers. */
2419 if (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0), 0))
2420 start = 0;
2421 else
2422 start = 1;
2424 tmps = alloca (sizeof (rtx) * XVECLEN (src, 0));
2426 /* Copy the (probable) hard regs into pseudos. */
2427 for (i = start; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
2429 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 0);
2430 tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (reg));
2431 emit_move_insn (tmps[i], reg);
2433 emit_queue ();
2435 /* If we won't be storing directly into memory, protect the real destination
2436 from strange tricks we might play. */
2437 dst = orig_dst;
2438 if (GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL)
2440 rtx temp;
2442 /* We can get a PARALLEL dst if there is a conditional expression in
2443 a return statement. In that case, the dst and src are the same,
2444 so no action is necessary. */
2445 if (rtx_equal_p (dst, src))
2446 return;
2448 /* It is unclear if we can ever reach here, but we may as well handle
2449 it. Allocate a temporary, and split this into a store/load to/from
2450 the temporary. */
2452 temp = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (dst), ssize, 0);
2453 emit_group_store (temp, src, type, ssize);
2454 emit_group_load (dst, temp, type, ssize);
2455 return;
2457 else if (GET_CODE (dst) != MEM && GET_CODE (dst) != CONCAT)
2459 dst = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (orig_dst));
2460 /* Make life a bit easier for combine. */
2461 emit_move_insn (dst, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (orig_dst)));
2464 /* Process the pieces. */
2465 for (i = start; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
2467 HOST_WIDE_INT bytepos = INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 1));
2468 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (tmps[i]);
2469 unsigned int bytelen = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2470 rtx dest = dst;
2472 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct. */
2473 if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen > ssize)
2475 /* store_bit_field always takes its value from the lsb.
2476 Move the fragment to the lsb if it's not already there. */
2477 if (
2478 #ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
2479 BLOCK_REG_PADDING (GET_MODE (orig_dst), type, i == start)
2480 == (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? upward : downward)
2481 #else
2482 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2483 #endif
2486 int shift = (bytelen - (ssize - bytepos)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2487 expand_binop (mode, ashr_optab, tmps[i], GEN_INT (shift),
2488 tmps[i], 0, OPTAB_WIDEN);
2490 bytelen = ssize - bytepos;
2493 if (GET_CODE (dst) == CONCAT)
2495 if (bytepos + bytelen <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0))))
2496 dest = XEXP (dst, 0);
2497 else if (bytepos >= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0))))
2499 bytepos -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0)));
2500 dest = XEXP (dst, 1);
2502 else if (bytepos == 0 && XVECLEN (src, 0))
2504 dest = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (dest),
2505 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest)), 0);
2506 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (dest, GET_MODE (tmps[i]), bytepos),
2507 tmps[i]);
2508 dst = dest;
2509 break;
2511 else
2512 abort ();
2515 /* Optimize the access just a bit. */
2516 if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM
2517 && (! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (dest))
2518 || MEM_ALIGN (dest) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2519 && bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) == 0
2520 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
2521 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (dest, mode, bytepos), tmps[i]);
2522 else
2523 store_bit_field (dest, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT, bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2524 mode, tmps[i], ssize);
2527 emit_queue ();
2529 /* Copy from the pseudo into the (probable) hard reg. */
2530 if (orig_dst != dst)
2531 emit_move_insn (orig_dst, dst);
2534 /* Generate code to copy a BLKmode object of TYPE out of a
2535 set of registers starting with SRCREG into TGTBLK. If TGTBLK
2536 is null, a stack temporary is created. TGTBLK is returned.
2538 The primary purpose of this routine is to handle functions
2539 that return BLKmode structures in registers. Some machines
2540 (the PA for example) want to return all small structures
2541 in registers regardless of the structure's alignment. */
2544 copy_blkmode_from_reg (rtx tgtblk, rtx srcreg, tree type)
2546 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
2547 rtx src = NULL, dst = NULL;
2548 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = MIN (TYPE_ALIGN (type), BITS_PER_WORD);
2549 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, xbitpos, big_endian_correction = 0;
2551 if (tgtblk == 0)
2553 tgtblk = assign_temp (build_qualified_type (type,
2554 (TYPE_QUALS (type)
2555 | TYPE_QUAL_CONST)),
2556 0, 1, 1);
2557 preserve_temp_slots (tgtblk);
2560 /* This code assumes srcreg is at least a full word. If it isn't, copy it
2561 into a new pseudo which is a full word. */
2563 if (GET_MODE (srcreg) != BLKmode
2564 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (srcreg)) < UNITS_PER_WORD)
2565 srcreg = convert_to_mode (word_mode, srcreg, TREE_UNSIGNED (type));
2567 /* Structures whose size is not a multiple of a word are aligned
2568 to the least significant byte (to the right). On a BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2569 machine, this means we must skip the empty high order bytes when
2570 calculating the bit offset. */
2571 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2572 && bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD)
2573 big_endian_correction
2574 = (BITS_PER_WORD - ((bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD) * BITS_PER_UNIT));
2576 /* Copy the structure BITSIZE bites at a time.
2578 We could probably emit more efficient code for machines which do not use
2579 strict alignment, but it doesn't seem worth the effort at the current
2580 time. */
2581 for (bitpos = 0, xbitpos = big_endian_correction;
2582 bitpos < bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2583 bitpos += bitsize, xbitpos += bitsize)
2585 /* We need a new source operand each time xbitpos is on a
2586 word boundary and when xbitpos == big_endian_correction
2587 (the first time through). */
2588 if (xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
2589 || xbitpos == big_endian_correction)
2590 src = operand_subword_force (srcreg, xbitpos / BITS_PER_WORD,
2591 GET_MODE (srcreg));
2593 /* We need a new destination operand each time bitpos is on
2594 a word boundary. */
2595 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0)
2596 dst = operand_subword (tgtblk, bitpos / BITS_PER_WORD, 1, BLKmode);
2598 /* Use xbitpos for the source extraction (right justified) and
2599 xbitpos for the destination store (left justified). */
2600 store_bit_field (dst, bitsize, bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, word_mode,
2601 extract_bit_field (src, bitsize,
2602 xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 1,
2603 NULL_RTX, word_mode, word_mode,
2604 BITS_PER_WORD),
2605 BITS_PER_WORD);
2608 return tgtblk;
2611 /* Add a USE expression for REG to the (possibly empty) list pointed
2612 to by CALL_FUSAGE. REG must denote a hard register. */
2614 void
2615 use_reg (rtx *call_fusage, rtx reg)
2617 if (GET_CODE (reg) != REG
2618 || REGNO (reg) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2619 abort ();
2621 *call_fusage
2622 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode,
2623 gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, reg), *call_fusage);
2626 /* Add USE expressions to *CALL_FUSAGE for each of NREGS consecutive regs,
2627 starting at REGNO. All of these registers must be hard registers. */
2629 void
2630 use_regs (rtx *call_fusage, int regno, int nregs)
2632 int i;
2634 if (regno + nregs > FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2635 abort ();
2637 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
2638 use_reg (call_fusage, regno_reg_rtx[regno + i]);
2641 /* Add USE expressions to *CALL_FUSAGE for each REG contained in the
2642 PARALLEL REGS. This is for calls that pass values in multiple
2643 non-contiguous locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
2645 void
2646 use_group_regs (rtx *call_fusage, rtx regs)
2648 int i;
2650 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); i++)
2652 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i), 0);
2654 /* A NULL entry means the parameter goes both on the stack and in
2655 registers. This can also be a MEM for targets that pass values
2656 partially on the stack and partially in registers. */
2657 if (reg != 0 && GET_CODE (reg) == REG)
2658 use_reg (call_fusage, reg);
2663 /* Determine whether the LEN bytes generated by CONSTFUN can be
2664 stored to memory using several move instructions. CONSTFUNDATA is
2665 a pointer which will be passed as argument in every CONSTFUN call.
2666 ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. Return nonzero if a
2667 call to store_by_pieces should succeed. */
2670 can_store_by_pieces (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
2671 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode),
2672 void *constfundata, unsigned int align)
2674 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_size, l;
2675 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
2676 enum machine_mode mode, tmode;
2677 enum insn_code icode;
2678 int reverse;
2679 rtx cst;
2681 if (len == 0)
2682 return 1;
2684 if (! STORE_BY_PIECES_P (len, align))
2685 return 0;
2687 if (! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (word_mode, align)
2688 || align > MOVE_MAX * BITS_PER_UNIT || align >= BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT)
2689 align = MOVE_MAX * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2691 /* We would first store what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
2692 successively smaller modes. */
2694 for (reverse = 0;
2695 reverse <= (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT || HAVE_POST_DECREMENT);
2696 reverse++)
2698 l = len;
2699 mode = VOIDmode;
2700 max_size = STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
2701 while (max_size > 1)
2703 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
2704 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
2705 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
2706 mode = tmode;
2708 if (mode == VOIDmode)
2709 break;
2711 icode = mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code;
2712 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing
2713 && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2715 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2717 while (l >= size)
2719 if (reverse)
2720 offset -= size;
2722 cst = (*constfun) (constfundata, offset, mode);
2723 if (!LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (cst))
2724 return 0;
2726 if (!reverse)
2727 offset += size;
2729 l -= size;
2733 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2736 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
2737 if (l != 0)
2738 abort ();
2741 return 1;
2744 /* Generate several move instructions to store LEN bytes generated by
2745 CONSTFUN to block TO. (A MEM rtx with BLKmode). CONSTFUNDATA is a
2746 pointer which will be passed as argument in every CONSTFUN call.
2747 ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume.
2748 If ENDP is 0 return to, if ENDP is 1 return memory at the end ala
2749 mempcpy, and if ENDP is 2 return memory the end minus one byte ala
2750 stpcpy. */
2753 store_by_pieces (rtx to, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
2754 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode),
2755 void *constfundata, unsigned int align, int endp)
2757 struct store_by_pieces data;
2759 if (len == 0)
2761 if (endp == 2)
2762 abort ();
2763 return to;
2766 if (! STORE_BY_PIECES_P (len, align))
2767 abort ();
2768 to = protect_from_queue (to, 1);
2769 data.constfun = constfun;
2770 data.constfundata = constfundata;
2771 data.len = len;
2772 data.to = to;
2773 store_by_pieces_1 (&data, align);
2774 if (endp)
2776 rtx to1;
2778 if (data.reverse)
2779 abort ();
2780 if (data.autinc_to)
2782 if (endp == 2)
2784 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data.explicit_inc_to > 0)
2785 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data.to_addr, constm1_rtx));
2786 else
2787 data.to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (data.to_addr,
2788 -1));
2790 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data.to, QImode, data.to_addr,
2791 data.offset);
2793 else
2795 if (endp == 2)
2796 --data.offset;
2797 to1 = adjust_address (data.to, QImode, data.offset);
2799 return to1;
2801 else
2802 return data.to;
2805 /* Generate several move instructions to clear LEN bytes of block TO. (A MEM
2806 rtx with BLKmode). The caller must pass TO through protect_from_queue
2807 before calling. ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. */
2809 static void
2810 clear_by_pieces (rtx to, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len, unsigned int align)
2812 struct store_by_pieces data;
2814 if (len == 0)
2815 return;
2817 data.constfun = clear_by_pieces_1;
2818 data.constfundata = NULL;
2819 data.len = len;
2820 data.to = to;
2821 store_by_pieces_1 (&data, align);
2824 /* Callback routine for clear_by_pieces.
2825 Return const0_rtx unconditionally. */
2827 static rtx
2828 clear_by_pieces_1 (void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2829 HOST_WIDE_INT offset ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2830 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2832 return const0_rtx;
2835 /* Subroutine of clear_by_pieces and store_by_pieces.
2836 Generate several move instructions to store LEN bytes of block TO. (A MEM
2837 rtx with BLKmode). The caller must pass TO through protect_from_queue
2838 before calling. ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. */
2840 static void
2841 store_by_pieces_1 (struct store_by_pieces *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2842 unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2844 rtx to_addr = XEXP (data->to, 0);
2845 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_size = STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
2846 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode, tmode;
2847 enum insn_code icode;
2849 data->offset = 0;
2850 data->to_addr = to_addr;
2851 data->autinc_to
2852 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC
2853 || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
2855 data->explicit_inc_to = 0;
2856 data->reverse
2857 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
2858 if (data->reverse)
2859 data->offset = data->len;
2861 /* If storing requires more than two move insns,
2862 copy addresses to registers (to make displacements shorter)
2863 and use post-increment if available. */
2864 if (!data->autinc_to
2865 && move_by_pieces_ninsns (data->len, align) > 2)
2867 /* Determine the main mode we'll be using. */
2868 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
2869 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
2870 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
2871 mode = tmode;
2873 if (USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data->reverse && ! data->autinc_to)
2875 data->to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (to_addr, data->len));
2876 data->autinc_to = 1;
2877 data->explicit_inc_to = -1;
2880 if (USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data->reverse
2881 && ! data->autinc_to)
2883 data->to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (to_addr);
2884 data->autinc_to = 1;
2885 data->explicit_inc_to = 1;
2888 if ( !data->autinc_to && CONSTANT_P (to_addr))
2889 data->to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (to_addr);
2892 if (! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (word_mode, align)
2893 || align > MOVE_MAX * BITS_PER_UNIT || align >= BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT)
2894 align = MOVE_MAX * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2896 /* First store what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
2897 successively smaller modes. */
2899 while (max_size > 1)
2901 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
2902 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
2903 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
2904 mode = tmode;
2906 if (mode == VOIDmode)
2907 break;
2909 icode = mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code;
2910 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2911 store_by_pieces_2 (GEN_FCN (icode), mode, data);
2913 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2916 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
2917 if (data->len != 0)
2918 abort ();
2921 /* Subroutine of store_by_pieces_1. Store as many bytes as appropriate
2922 with move instructions for mode MODE. GENFUN is the gen_... function
2923 to make a move insn for that mode. DATA has all the other info. */
2925 static void
2926 store_by_pieces_2 (rtx (*genfun) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode mode,
2927 struct store_by_pieces *data)
2929 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2930 rtx to1, cst;
2932 while (data->len >= size)
2934 if (data->reverse)
2935 data->offset -= size;
2937 if (data->autinc_to)
2938 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->to, mode, data->to_addr,
2939 data->offset);
2940 else
2941 to1 = adjust_address (data->to, mode, data->offset);
2943 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to < 0)
2944 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr,
2945 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT) size)));
2947 cst = (*data->constfun) (data->constfundata, data->offset, mode);
2948 emit_insn ((*genfun) (to1, cst));
2950 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to > 0)
2951 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
2953 if (! data->reverse)
2954 data->offset += size;
2956 data->len -= size;
2960 /* Write zeros through the storage of OBJECT. If OBJECT has BLKmode, SIZE is
2961 its length in bytes. */
2964 clear_storage (rtx object, rtx size)
2966 rtx retval = 0;
2967 unsigned int align = (GET_CODE (object) == MEM ? MEM_ALIGN (object)
2968 : GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (GET_MODE (object)));
2970 /* If OBJECT is not BLKmode and SIZE is the same size as its mode,
2971 just move a zero. Otherwise, do this a piece at a time. */
2972 if (GET_MODE (object) != BLKmode
2973 && GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
2974 && INTVAL (size) == (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (object)))
2975 emit_move_insn (object, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (object)));
2976 else
2978 object = protect_from_queue (object, 1);
2979 size = protect_from_queue (size, 0);
2981 if (size == const0_rtx)
2983 else if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
2984 && CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (INTVAL (size), align))
2985 clear_by_pieces (object, INTVAL (size), align);
2986 else if (clear_storage_via_clrstr (object, size, align))
2988 else
2989 retval = clear_storage_via_libcall (object, size);
2992 return retval;
2995 /* A subroutine of clear_storage. Expand a clrstr pattern;
2996 return true if successful. */
2998 static bool
2999 clear_storage_via_clrstr (rtx object, rtx size, unsigned int align)
3001 /* Try the most limited insn first, because there's no point
3002 including more than one in the machine description unless
3003 the more limited one has some advantage. */
3005 rtx opalign = GEN_INT (align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
3006 enum machine_mode mode;
3008 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT); mode != VOIDmode;
3009 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
3011 enum insn_code code = clrstr_optab[(int) mode];
3012 insn_operand_predicate_fn pred;
3014 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
3015 /* We don't need MODE to be narrower than
3016 BITS_PER_HOST_WIDE_INT here because if SIZE is less than
3017 the mode mask, as it is returned by the macro, it will
3018 definitely be less than the actual mode mask. */
3019 && ((GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
3020 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
3021 <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
3022 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= BITS_PER_WORD)
3023 && ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[0].predicate) == 0
3024 || (*pred) (object, BLKmode))
3025 && ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[2].predicate) == 0
3026 || (*pred) (opalign, VOIDmode)))
3028 rtx op1;
3029 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
3030 rtx pat;
3032 op1 = convert_to_mode (mode, size, 1);
3033 pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[1].predicate;
3034 if (pred != 0 && ! (*pred) (op1, mode))
3035 op1 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, op1);
3037 pat = GEN_FCN ((int) code) (object, op1, opalign);
3038 if (pat)
3040 emit_insn (pat);
3041 return true;
3043 else
3044 delete_insns_since (last);
3048 return false;
3051 /* A subroutine of clear_storage. Expand a call to memset or bzero.
3052 Return the return value of memset, 0 otherwise. */
3054 static rtx
3055 clear_storage_via_libcall (rtx object, rtx size)
3057 tree call_expr, arg_list, fn, object_tree, size_tree;
3058 enum machine_mode size_mode;
3059 rtx retval;
3061 /* OBJECT or SIZE may have been passed through protect_from_queue.
3063 It is unsafe to save the value generated by protect_from_queue
3064 and reuse it later. Consider what happens if emit_queue is
3065 called before the return value from protect_from_queue is used.
3067 Expansion of the CALL_EXPR below will call emit_queue before
3068 we are finished emitting RTL for argument setup. So if we are
3069 not careful we could get the wrong value for an argument.
3071 To avoid this problem we go ahead and emit code to copy OBJECT
3072 and SIZE into new pseudos. We can then place those new pseudos
3073 into an RTL_EXPR and use them later, even after a call to
3074 emit_queue.
3076 Note this is not strictly needed for library calls since they
3077 do not call emit_queue before loading their arguments. However,
3078 we may need to have library calls call emit_queue in the future
3079 since failing to do so could cause problems for targets which
3080 define SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES and pass arguments in registers. */
3082 object = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, XEXP (object, 0));
3084 if (TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS)
3085 size_mode = TYPE_MODE (sizetype);
3086 else
3087 size_mode = TYPE_MODE (unsigned_type_node);
3088 size = convert_to_mode (size_mode, size, 1);
3089 size = copy_to_mode_reg (size_mode, size);
3091 /* It is incorrect to use the libcall calling conventions to call
3092 memset in this context. This could be a user call to memset and
3093 the user may wish to examine the return value from memset. For
3094 targets where libcalls and normal calls have different conventions
3095 for returning pointers, we could end up generating incorrect code.
3097 For convenience, we generate the call to bzero this way as well. */
3099 object_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, object);
3100 if (TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS)
3101 size_tree = make_tree (sizetype, size);
3102 else
3103 size_tree = make_tree (unsigned_type_node, size);
3105 fn = clear_storage_libcall_fn (true);
3106 arg_list = tree_cons (NULL_TREE, size_tree, NULL_TREE);
3107 if (TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS)
3108 arg_list = tree_cons (NULL_TREE, integer_zero_node, arg_list);
3109 arg_list = tree_cons (NULL_TREE, object_tree, arg_list);
3111 /* Now we have to build up the CALL_EXPR itself. */
3112 call_expr = build1 (ADDR_EXPR, build_pointer_type (TREE_TYPE (fn)), fn);
3113 call_expr = build (CALL_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (fn)),
3114 call_expr, arg_list, NULL_TREE);
3115 TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (call_expr) = 1;
3117 retval = expand_expr (call_expr, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
3119 /* If we are initializing a readonly value, show the above call
3120 clobbered it. Otherwise, a load from it may erroneously be
3121 hoisted from a loop. */
3122 if (RTX_UNCHANGING_P (object))
3123 emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, object));
3125 return (TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS ? retval : NULL_RTX);
3128 /* A subroutine of clear_storage_via_libcall. Create the tree node
3129 for the function we use for block clears. The first time FOR_CALL
3130 is true, we call assemble_external. */
3132 static GTY(()) tree block_clear_fn;
3134 void
3135 init_block_clear_fn (const char *asmspec)
3137 if (!block_clear_fn)
3139 tree fn, args;
3141 if (TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS)
3143 fn = get_identifier ("memset");
3144 args = build_function_type_list (ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node,
3145 integer_type_node, sizetype,
3146 NULL_TREE);
3148 else
3150 fn = get_identifier ("bzero");
3151 args = build_function_type_list (void_type_node, ptr_type_node,
3152 unsigned_type_node, NULL_TREE);
3155 fn = build_decl (FUNCTION_DECL, fn, args);
3156 DECL_EXTERNAL (fn) = 1;
3157 TREE_PUBLIC (fn) = 1;
3158 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (fn) = 1;
3159 TREE_NOTHROW (fn) = 1;
3161 block_clear_fn = fn;
3164 if (asmspec)
3166 SET_DECL_RTL (block_clear_fn, NULL_RTX);
3167 SET_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (block_clear_fn, get_identifier (asmspec));
3171 static tree
3172 clear_storage_libcall_fn (int for_call)
3174 static bool emitted_extern;
3176 if (!block_clear_fn)
3177 init_block_clear_fn (NULL);
3179 if (for_call && !emitted_extern)
3181 emitted_extern = true;
3182 make_decl_rtl (block_clear_fn, NULL);
3183 assemble_external (block_clear_fn);
3186 return block_clear_fn;
3189 /* Generate code to copy Y into X.
3190 Both Y and X must have the same mode, except that
3191 Y can be a constant with VOIDmode.
3192 This mode cannot be BLKmode; use emit_block_move for that.
3194 Return the last instruction emitted. */
3197 emit_move_insn (rtx x, rtx y)
3199 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
3200 rtx y_cst = NULL_RTX;
3201 rtx last_insn, set;
3203 x = protect_from_queue (x, 1);
3204 y = protect_from_queue (y, 0);
3206 if (mode == BLKmode || (GET_MODE (y) != mode && GET_MODE (y) != VOIDmode))
3207 abort ();
3209 /* Never force constant_p_rtx to memory. */
3210 if (GET_CODE (y) == CONSTANT_P_RTX)
3212 else if (CONSTANT_P (y))
3214 if (optimize
3215 && SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (x))
3216 && (last_insn = compress_float_constant (x, y)))
3217 return last_insn;
3219 y_cst = y;
3221 if (!LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (y))
3223 y = force_const_mem (mode, y);
3225 /* If the target's cannot_force_const_mem prevented the spill,
3226 assume that the target's move expanders will also take care
3227 of the non-legitimate constant. */
3228 if (!y)
3229 y = y_cst;
3233 /* If X or Y are memory references, verify that their addresses are valid
3234 for the machine. */
3235 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM
3236 && ((! memory_address_p (GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0))
3237 && ! push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x)))
3238 || (flag_force_addr
3239 && CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (XEXP (x, 0)))))
3240 x = validize_mem (x);
3242 if (GET_CODE (y) == MEM
3243 && (! memory_address_p (GET_MODE (y), XEXP (y, 0))
3244 || (flag_force_addr
3245 && CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (XEXP (y, 0)))))
3246 y = validize_mem (y);
3248 if (mode == BLKmode)
3249 abort ();
3251 last_insn = emit_move_insn_1 (x, y);
3253 if (y_cst && GET_CODE (x) == REG
3254 && (set = single_set (last_insn)) != NULL_RTX
3255 && SET_DEST (set) == x
3256 && ! rtx_equal_p (y_cst, SET_SRC (set)))
3257 set_unique_reg_note (last_insn, REG_EQUAL, y_cst);
3259 return last_insn;
3262 /* Low level part of emit_move_insn.
3263 Called just like emit_move_insn, but assumes X and Y
3264 are basically valid. */
3267 emit_move_insn_1 (rtx x, rtx y)
3269 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
3270 enum machine_mode submode;
3271 enum mode_class class = GET_MODE_CLASS (mode);
3273 if ((unsigned int) mode >= (unsigned int) MAX_MACHINE_MODE)
3274 abort ();
3276 if (mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3277 return
3278 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code) (x, y));
3280 /* Expand complex moves by moving real part and imag part, if possible. */
3281 else if ((class == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT || class == MODE_COMPLEX_INT)
3282 && BLKmode != (submode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode))
3283 && (mov_optab->handlers[(int) submode].insn_code
3284 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
3286 /* Don't split destination if it is a stack push. */
3287 int stack = push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x));
3289 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3290 /* In case we output to the stack, but the size is smaller than the
3291 machine can push exactly, we need to use move instructions. */
3292 if (stack
3293 && (PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (submode))
3294 != GET_MODE_SIZE (submode)))
3296 rtx temp;
3297 HOST_WIDE_INT offset1, offset2;
3299 /* Do not use anti_adjust_stack, since we don't want to update
3300 stack_pointer_delta. */
3301 temp = expand_binop (Pmode,
3302 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3303 sub_optab,
3304 #else
3305 add_optab,
3306 #endif
3307 stack_pointer_rtx,
3308 GEN_INT
3309 (PUSH_ROUNDING
3310 (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)))),
3311 stack_pointer_rtx, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3313 if (temp != stack_pointer_rtx)
3314 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, temp);
3316 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3317 offset1 = 0;
3318 offset2 = GET_MODE_SIZE (submode);
3319 #else
3320 offset1 = -PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)));
3321 offset2 = (-PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)))
3322 + GET_MODE_SIZE (submode));
3323 #endif
3325 emit_move_insn (change_address (x, submode,
3326 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
3327 stack_pointer_rtx,
3328 GEN_INT (offset1))),
3329 gen_realpart (submode, y));
3330 emit_move_insn (change_address (x, submode,
3331 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
3332 stack_pointer_rtx,
3333 GEN_INT (offset2))),
3334 gen_imagpart (submode, y));
3336 else
3337 #endif
3338 /* If this is a stack, push the highpart first, so it
3339 will be in the argument order.
3341 In that case, change_address is used only to convert
3342 the mode, not to change the address. */
3343 if (stack)
3345 /* Note that the real part always precedes the imag part in memory
3346 regardless of machine's endianness. */
3347 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3348 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
3349 gen_imagpart (submode, y));
3350 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
3351 gen_realpart (submode, y));
3352 #else
3353 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
3354 gen_realpart (submode, y));
3355 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
3356 gen_imagpart (submode, y));
3357 #endif
3359 else
3361 rtx realpart_x, realpart_y;
3362 rtx imagpart_x, imagpart_y;
3364 /* If this is a complex value with each part being smaller than a
3365 word, the usual calling sequence will likely pack the pieces into
3366 a single register. Unfortunately, SUBREG of hard registers only
3367 deals in terms of words, so we have a problem converting input
3368 arguments to the CONCAT of two registers that is used elsewhere
3369 for complex values. If this is before reload, we can copy it into
3370 memory and reload. FIXME, we should see about using extract and
3371 insert on integer registers, but complex short and complex char
3372 variables should be rarely used. */
3373 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) < 2 * BITS_PER_WORD
3374 && (reload_in_progress | reload_completed) == 0)
3376 int packed_dest_p
3377 = (REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
3378 int packed_src_p
3379 = (REG_P (y) && REGNO (y) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
3381 if (packed_dest_p || packed_src_p)
3383 enum mode_class reg_class = ((class == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT)
3384 ? MODE_FLOAT : MODE_INT);
3386 enum machine_mode reg_mode
3387 = mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), reg_class, 1);
3389 if (reg_mode != BLKmode)
3391 rtx mem = assign_stack_temp (reg_mode,
3392 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
3393 rtx cmem = adjust_address (mem, mode, 0);
3395 cfun->cannot_inline
3396 = N_("function using short complex types cannot be inline");
3398 if (packed_dest_p)
3400 rtx sreg = gen_rtx_SUBREG (reg_mode, x, 0);
3402 emit_move_insn_1 (cmem, y);
3403 return emit_move_insn_1 (sreg, mem);
3405 else
3407 rtx sreg = gen_rtx_SUBREG (reg_mode, y, 0);
3409 emit_move_insn_1 (mem, sreg);
3410 return emit_move_insn_1 (x, cmem);
3416 realpart_x = gen_realpart (submode, x);
3417 realpart_y = gen_realpart (submode, y);
3418 imagpart_x = gen_imagpart (submode, x);
3419 imagpart_y = gen_imagpart (submode, y);
3421 /* Show the output dies here. This is necessary for SUBREGs
3422 of pseudos since we cannot track their lifetimes correctly;
3423 hard regs shouldn't appear here except as return values.
3424 We never want to emit such a clobber after reload. */
3425 if (x != y
3426 && ! (reload_in_progress || reload_completed)
3427 && (GET_CODE (realpart_x) == SUBREG
3428 || GET_CODE (imagpart_x) == SUBREG))
3429 emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, x));
3431 emit_move_insn (realpart_x, realpart_y);
3432 emit_move_insn (imagpart_x, imagpart_y);
3435 return get_last_insn ();
3438 /* Handle MODE_CC modes: If we don't have a special move insn for this mode,
3439 find a mode to do it in. If we have a movcc, use it. Otherwise,
3440 find the MODE_INT mode of the same width. */
3441 else if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_CC
3442 && mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code == CODE_FOR_nothing)
3444 enum insn_code insn_code;
3445 enum machine_mode tmode = VOIDmode;
3446 rtx x1 = x, y1 = y;
3448 if (mode != CCmode
3449 && mov_optab->handlers[(int) CCmode].insn_code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3450 tmode = CCmode;
3451 else
3452 for (tmode = QImode; tmode != VOIDmode;
3453 tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
3454 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
3455 break;
3457 if (tmode == VOIDmode)
3458 abort ();
3460 /* Get X and Y in TMODE. We can't use gen_lowpart here because it
3461 may call change_address which is not appropriate if we were
3462 called when a reload was in progress. We don't have to worry
3463 about changing the address since the size in bytes is supposed to
3464 be the same. Copy the MEM to change the mode and move any
3465 substitutions from the old MEM to the new one. */
3467 if (reload_in_progress)
3469 x = gen_lowpart_common (tmode, x1);
3470 if (x == 0 && GET_CODE (x1) == MEM)
3472 x = adjust_address_nv (x1, tmode, 0);
3473 copy_replacements (x1, x);
3476 y = gen_lowpart_common (tmode, y1);
3477 if (y == 0 && GET_CODE (y1) == MEM)
3479 y = adjust_address_nv (y1, tmode, 0);
3480 copy_replacements (y1, y);
3483 else
3485 x = gen_lowpart (tmode, x);
3486 y = gen_lowpart (tmode, y);
3489 insn_code = mov_optab->handlers[(int) tmode].insn_code;
3490 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (insn_code) (x, y));
3493 /* This will handle any multi-word or full-word mode that lacks a move_insn
3494 pattern. However, you will get better code if you define such patterns,
3495 even if they must turn into multiple assembler instructions. */
3496 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) >= UNITS_PER_WORD)
3498 rtx last_insn = 0;
3499 rtx seq, inner;
3500 int need_clobber;
3501 int i;
3503 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3505 /* If X is a push on the stack, do the push now and replace
3506 X with a reference to the stack pointer. */
3507 if (push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x)))
3509 rtx temp;
3510 enum rtx_code code;
3512 /* Do not use anti_adjust_stack, since we don't want to update
3513 stack_pointer_delta. */
3514 temp = expand_binop (Pmode,
3515 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3516 sub_optab,
3517 #else
3518 add_optab,
3519 #endif
3520 stack_pointer_rtx,
3521 GEN_INT
3522 (PUSH_ROUNDING
3523 (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)))),
3524 stack_pointer_rtx, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3526 if (temp != stack_pointer_rtx)
3527 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, temp);
3529 code = GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0));
3531 /* Just hope that small offsets off SP are OK. */
3532 if (code == POST_INC)
3533 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
3534 GEN_INT (-((HOST_WIDE_INT)
3535 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)))));
3536 else if (code == POST_DEC)
3537 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
3538 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))));
3539 else
3540 temp = stack_pointer_rtx;
3542 x = change_address (x, VOIDmode, temp);
3544 #endif
3546 /* If we are in reload, see if either operand is a MEM whose address
3547 is scheduled for replacement. */
3548 if (reload_in_progress && GET_CODE (x) == MEM
3549 && (inner = find_replacement (&XEXP (x, 0))) != XEXP (x, 0))
3550 x = replace_equiv_address_nv (x, inner);
3551 if (reload_in_progress && GET_CODE (y) == MEM
3552 && (inner = find_replacement (&XEXP (y, 0))) != XEXP (y, 0))
3553 y = replace_equiv_address_nv (y, inner);
3555 start_sequence ();
3557 need_clobber = 0;
3558 for (i = 0;
3559 i < (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + (UNITS_PER_WORD - 1)) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
3560 i++)
3562 rtx xpart = operand_subword (x, i, 1, mode);
3563 rtx ypart = operand_subword (y, i, 1, mode);
3565 /* If we can't get a part of Y, put Y into memory if it is a
3566 constant. Otherwise, force it into a register. If we still
3567 can't get a part of Y, abort. */
3568 if (ypart == 0 && CONSTANT_P (y))
3570 y = force_const_mem (mode, y);
3571 ypart = operand_subword (y, i, 1, mode);
3573 else if (ypart == 0)
3574 ypart = operand_subword_force (y, i, mode);
3576 if (xpart == 0 || ypart == 0)
3577 abort ();
3579 need_clobber |= (GET_CODE (xpart) == SUBREG);
3581 last_insn = emit_move_insn (xpart, ypart);
3584 seq = get_insns ();
3585 end_sequence ();
3587 /* Show the output dies here. This is necessary for SUBREGs
3588 of pseudos since we cannot track their lifetimes correctly;
3589 hard regs shouldn't appear here except as return values.
3590 We never want to emit such a clobber after reload. */
3591 if (x != y
3592 && ! (reload_in_progress || reload_completed)
3593 && need_clobber != 0)
3594 emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, x));
3596 emit_insn (seq);
3598 return last_insn;
3600 else
3601 abort ();
3604 /* If Y is representable exactly in a narrower mode, and the target can
3605 perform the extension directly from constant or memory, then emit the
3606 move as an extension. */
3608 static rtx
3609 compress_float_constant (rtx x, rtx y)
3611 enum machine_mode dstmode = GET_MODE (x);
3612 enum machine_mode orig_srcmode = GET_MODE (y);
3613 enum machine_mode srcmode;
3614 REAL_VALUE_TYPE r;
3616 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (r, y);
3618 for (srcmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (GET_MODE_CLASS (orig_srcmode));
3619 srcmode != orig_srcmode;
3620 srcmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (srcmode))
3622 enum insn_code ic;
3623 rtx trunc_y, last_insn;
3625 /* Skip if the target can't extend this way. */
3626 ic = can_extend_p (dstmode, srcmode, 0);
3627 if (ic == CODE_FOR_nothing)
3628 continue;
3630 /* Skip if the narrowed value isn't exact. */
3631 if (! exact_real_truncate (srcmode, &r))
3632 continue;
3634 trunc_y = CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (r, srcmode);
3636 if (LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (trunc_y))
3638 /* Skip if the target needs extra instructions to perform
3639 the extension. */
3640 if (! (*insn_data[ic].operand[1].predicate) (trunc_y, srcmode))
3641 continue;
3643 else if (float_extend_from_mem[dstmode][srcmode])
3644 trunc_y = validize_mem (force_const_mem (srcmode, trunc_y));
3645 else
3646 continue;
3648 emit_unop_insn (ic, x, trunc_y, UNKNOWN);
3649 last_insn = get_last_insn ();
3651 if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
3652 set_unique_reg_note (last_insn, REG_EQUAL, y);
3654 return last_insn;
3657 return NULL_RTX;
3660 /* Pushing data onto the stack. */
3662 /* Push a block of length SIZE (perhaps variable)
3663 and return an rtx to address the beginning of the block.
3664 Note that it is not possible for the value returned to be a QUEUED.
3665 The value may be virtual_outgoing_args_rtx.
3667 EXTRA is the number of bytes of padding to push in addition to SIZE.
3668 BELOW nonzero means this padding comes at low addresses;
3669 otherwise, the padding comes at high addresses. */
3672 push_block (rtx size, int extra, int below)
3674 rtx temp;
3676 size = convert_modes (Pmode, ptr_mode, size, 1);
3677 if (CONSTANT_P (size))
3678 anti_adjust_stack (plus_constant (size, extra));
3679 else if (GET_CODE (size) == REG && extra == 0)
3680 anti_adjust_stack (size);
3681 else
3683 temp = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, size);
3684 if (extra != 0)
3685 temp = expand_binop (Pmode, add_optab, temp, GEN_INT (extra),
3686 temp, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3687 anti_adjust_stack (temp);
3690 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3691 if (0)
3692 #else
3693 if (1)
3694 #endif
3696 temp = virtual_outgoing_args_rtx;
3697 if (extra != 0 && below)
3698 temp = plus_constant (temp, extra);
3700 else
3702 if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT)
3703 temp = plus_constant (virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
3704 -INTVAL (size) - (below ? 0 : extra));
3705 else if (extra != 0 && !below)
3706 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
3707 negate_rtx (Pmode, plus_constant (size, extra)));
3708 else
3709 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
3710 negate_rtx (Pmode, size));
3713 return memory_address (GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), temp);
3716 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3718 /* Emit single push insn. */
3720 static void
3721 emit_single_push_insn (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, tree type)
3723 rtx dest_addr;
3724 unsigned rounded_size = PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
3725 rtx dest;
3726 enum insn_code icode;
3727 insn_operand_predicate_fn pred;
3729 stack_pointer_delta += PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
3730 /* If there is push pattern, use it. Otherwise try old way of throwing
3731 MEM representing push operation to move expander. */
3732 icode = push_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code;
3733 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3735 if (((pred = insn_data[(int) icode].operand[0].predicate)
3736 && !((*pred) (x, mode))))
3737 x = force_reg (mode, x);
3738 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (x));
3739 return;
3741 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == rounded_size)
3742 dest_addr = gen_rtx_fmt_e (STACK_PUSH_CODE, Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx);
3743 /* If we are to pad downward, adjust the stack pointer first and
3744 then store X into the stack location using an offset. This is
3745 because emit_move_insn does not know how to pad; it does not have
3746 access to type. */
3747 else if (FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (mode, type) == downward)
3749 unsigned padding_size = rounded_size - GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
3750 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
3752 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
3753 expand_binop (Pmode,
3754 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3755 sub_optab,
3756 #else
3757 add_optab,
3758 #endif
3759 stack_pointer_rtx,
3760 GEN_INT (rounded_size),
3761 NULL_RTX, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN));
3763 offset = (HOST_WIDE_INT) padding_size;
3764 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3765 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC)
3766 /* We have already decremented the stack pointer, so get the
3767 previous value. */
3768 offset += (HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size;
3769 #else
3770 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_INC)
3771 /* We have already incremented the stack pointer, so get the
3772 previous value. */
3773 offset -= (HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size;
3774 #endif
3775 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, GEN_INT (offset));
3777 else
3779 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3780 /* ??? This seems wrong if STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC. */
3781 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
3782 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size));
3783 #else
3784 /* ??? This seems wrong if STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_INC. */
3785 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
3786 GEN_INT (rounded_size));
3787 #endif
3788 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PRE_MODIFY (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, dest_addr);
3791 dest = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, dest_addr);
3793 if (type != 0)
3795 set_mem_attributes (dest, type, 1);
3797 if (flag_optimize_sibling_calls)
3798 /* Function incoming arguments may overlap with sibling call
3799 outgoing arguments and we cannot allow reordering of reads
3800 from function arguments with stores to outgoing arguments
3801 of sibling calls. */
3802 set_mem_alias_set (dest, 0);
3804 emit_move_insn (dest, x);
3806 #endif
3808 /* Generate code to push X onto the stack, assuming it has mode MODE and
3809 type TYPE.
3810 MODE is redundant except when X is a CONST_INT (since they don't
3811 carry mode info).
3812 SIZE is an rtx for the size of data to be copied (in bytes),
3813 needed only if X is BLKmode.
3815 ALIGN (in bits) is maximum alignment we can assume.
3817 If PARTIAL and REG are both nonzero, then copy that many of the first
3818 words of X into registers starting with REG, and push the rest of X.
3819 The amount of space pushed is decreased by PARTIAL words,
3820 rounded *down* to a multiple of PARM_BOUNDARY.
3821 REG must be a hard register in this case.
3822 If REG is zero but PARTIAL is not, take any all others actions for an
3823 argument partially in registers, but do not actually load any
3824 registers.
3826 EXTRA is the amount in bytes of extra space to leave next to this arg.
3827 This is ignored if an argument block has already been allocated.
3829 On a machine that lacks real push insns, ARGS_ADDR is the address of
3830 the bottom of the argument block for this call. We use indexing off there
3831 to store the arg. On machines with push insns, ARGS_ADDR is 0 when a
3832 argument block has not been preallocated.
3834 ARGS_SO_FAR is the size of args previously pushed for this call.
3836 REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE is nonzero if functions require stack space
3837 for arguments passed in registers. If nonzero, it will be the number
3838 of bytes required. */
3840 void
3841 emit_push_insn (rtx x, enum machine_mode mode, tree type, rtx size,
3842 unsigned int align, int partial, rtx reg, int extra,
3843 rtx args_addr, rtx args_so_far, int reg_parm_stack_space,
3844 rtx alignment_pad)
3846 rtx xinner;
3847 enum direction stack_direction
3848 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3849 = downward;
3850 #else
3851 = upward;
3852 #endif
3854 /* Decide where to pad the argument: `downward' for below,
3855 `upward' for above, or `none' for don't pad it.
3856 Default is below for small data on big-endian machines; else above. */
3857 enum direction where_pad = FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (mode, type);
3859 /* Invert direction if stack is post-decrement.
3860 FIXME: why? */
3861 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC)
3862 if (where_pad != none)
3863 where_pad = (where_pad == downward ? upward : downward);
3865 xinner = x = protect_from_queue (x, 0);
3867 if (mode == BLKmode)
3869 /* Copy a block into the stack, entirely or partially. */
3871 rtx temp;
3872 int used = partial * UNITS_PER_WORD;
3873 int offset = used % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
3874 int skip;
3876 if (size == 0)
3877 abort ();
3879 used -= offset;
3881 /* USED is now the # of bytes we need not copy to the stack
3882 because registers will take care of them. */
3884 if (partial != 0)
3885 xinner = adjust_address (xinner, BLKmode, used);
3887 /* If the partial register-part of the arg counts in its stack size,
3888 skip the part of stack space corresponding to the registers.
3889 Otherwise, start copying to the beginning of the stack space,
3890 by setting SKIP to 0. */
3891 skip = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0) ? 0 : used;
3893 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3894 /* Do it with several push insns if that doesn't take lots of insns
3895 and if there is no difficulty with push insns that skip bytes
3896 on the stack for alignment purposes. */
3897 if (args_addr == 0
3898 && PUSH_ARGS
3899 && GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
3900 && skip == 0
3901 && MEM_ALIGN (xinner) >= align
3902 && (MOVE_BY_PIECES_P ((unsigned) INTVAL (size) - used, align))
3903 /* Here we avoid the case of a structure whose weak alignment
3904 forces many pushes of a small amount of data,
3905 and such small pushes do rounding that causes trouble. */
3906 && ((! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (word_mode, align))
3907 || align >= BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
3908 || (PUSH_ROUNDING (align / BITS_PER_UNIT)
3909 == (align / BITS_PER_UNIT)))
3910 && PUSH_ROUNDING (INTVAL (size)) == INTVAL (size))
3912 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
3913 or if padding below and stack grows up.
3914 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
3915 if (extra && args_addr == 0
3916 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
3917 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
3919 move_by_pieces (NULL, xinner, INTVAL (size) - used, align, 0);
3921 else
3922 #endif /* PUSH_ROUNDING */
3924 rtx target;
3926 /* Otherwise make space on the stack and copy the data
3927 to the address of that space. */
3929 /* Deduct words put into registers from the size we must copy. */
3930 if (partial != 0)
3932 if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT)
3933 size = GEN_INT (INTVAL (size) - used);
3934 else
3935 size = expand_binop (GET_MODE (size), sub_optab, size,
3936 GEN_INT (used), NULL_RTX, 0,
3937 OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3940 /* Get the address of the stack space.
3941 In this case, we do not deal with EXTRA separately.
3942 A single stack adjust will do. */
3943 if (! args_addr)
3945 temp = push_block (size, extra, where_pad == downward);
3946 extra = 0;
3948 else if (GET_CODE (args_so_far) == CONST_INT)
3949 temp = memory_address (BLKmode,
3950 plus_constant (args_addr,
3951 skip + INTVAL (args_so_far)));
3952 else
3953 temp = memory_address (BLKmode,
3954 plus_constant (gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
3955 args_addr,
3956 args_so_far),
3957 skip));
3959 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
3961 /* If the source is referenced relative to the stack pointer,
3962 copy it to another register to stabilize it. We do not need
3963 to do this if we know that we won't be changing sp. */
3965 if (reg_mentioned_p (virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx, temp)
3966 || reg_mentioned_p (virtual_outgoing_args_rtx, temp))
3967 temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
3970 target = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, temp);
3972 if (type != 0)
3974 set_mem_attributes (target, type, 1);
3975 /* Function incoming arguments may overlap with sibling call
3976 outgoing arguments and we cannot allow reordering of reads
3977 from function arguments with stores to outgoing arguments
3978 of sibling calls. */
3979 set_mem_alias_set (target, 0);
3982 /* ALIGN may well be better aligned than TYPE, e.g. due to
3983 PARM_BOUNDARY. Assume the caller isn't lying. */
3984 set_mem_align (target, align);
3986 emit_block_move (target, xinner, size, BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM);
3989 else if (partial > 0)
3991 /* Scalar partly in registers. */
3993 int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
3994 int i;
3995 int not_stack;
3996 /* # words of start of argument
3997 that we must make space for but need not store. */
3998 int offset = partial % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_WORD);
3999 int args_offset = INTVAL (args_so_far);
4000 int skip;
4002 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
4003 or if padding below and stack grows up.
4004 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
4005 if (extra && args_addr == 0
4006 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
4007 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
4009 /* If we make space by pushing it, we might as well push
4010 the real data. Otherwise, we can leave OFFSET nonzero
4011 and leave the space uninitialized. */
4012 if (args_addr == 0)
4013 offset = 0;
4015 /* Now NOT_STACK gets the number of words that we don't need to
4016 allocate on the stack. */
4017 not_stack = partial - offset;
4019 /* If the partial register-part of the arg counts in its stack size,
4020 skip the part of stack space corresponding to the registers.
4021 Otherwise, start copying to the beginning of the stack space,
4022 by setting SKIP to 0. */
4023 skip = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0) ? 0 : not_stack;
4025 if (CONSTANT_P (x) && ! LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (x))
4026 x = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, x));
4028 /* If X is a hard register in a non-integer mode, copy it into a pseudo;
4029 SUBREGs of such registers are not allowed. */
4030 if ((GET_CODE (x) == REG && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
4031 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) != MODE_INT))
4032 x = copy_to_reg (x);
4034 /* Loop over all the words allocated on the stack for this arg. */
4035 /* We can do it by words, because any scalar bigger than a word
4036 has a size a multiple of a word. */
4037 #ifndef PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
4038 for (i = not_stack; i < size; i++)
4039 #else
4040 for (i = size - 1; i >= not_stack; i--)
4041 #endif
4042 if (i >= not_stack + offset)
4043 emit_push_insn (operand_subword_force (x, i, mode),
4044 word_mode, NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX, align, 0, NULL_RTX,
4045 0, args_addr,
4046 GEN_INT (args_offset + ((i - not_stack + skip)
4047 * UNITS_PER_WORD)),
4048 reg_parm_stack_space, alignment_pad);
4050 else
4052 rtx addr;
4053 rtx dest;
4055 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
4056 or if padding below and stack grows up.
4057 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
4058 if (extra && args_addr == 0
4059 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
4060 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
4062 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
4063 if (args_addr == 0 && PUSH_ARGS)
4064 emit_single_push_insn (mode, x, type);
4065 else
4066 #endif
4068 if (GET_CODE (args_so_far) == CONST_INT)
4069 addr
4070 = memory_address (mode,
4071 plus_constant (args_addr,
4072 INTVAL (args_so_far)));
4073 else
4074 addr = memory_address (mode, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, args_addr,
4075 args_so_far));
4076 dest = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, addr);
4077 if (type != 0)
4079 set_mem_attributes (dest, type, 1);
4080 /* Function incoming arguments may overlap with sibling call
4081 outgoing arguments and we cannot allow reordering of reads
4082 from function arguments with stores to outgoing arguments
4083 of sibling calls. */
4084 set_mem_alias_set (dest, 0);
4087 emit_move_insn (dest, x);
4091 /* If part should go in registers, copy that part
4092 into the appropriate registers. Do this now, at the end,
4093 since mem-to-mem copies above may do function calls. */
4094 if (partial > 0 && reg != 0)
4096 /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
4097 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
4098 if (GET_CODE (reg) == PARALLEL)
4099 emit_group_load (reg, x, type, -1);
4100 else
4101 move_block_to_reg (REGNO (reg), x, partial, mode);
4104 if (extra && args_addr == 0 && where_pad == stack_direction)
4105 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
4107 if (alignment_pad && args_addr == 0)
4108 anti_adjust_stack (alignment_pad);
4111 /* Return X if X can be used as a subtarget in a sequence of arithmetic
4112 operations. */
4114 static rtx
4115 get_subtarget (rtx x)
4117 return ((x == 0
4118 /* Only registers can be subtargets. */
4119 || GET_CODE (x) != REG
4120 /* If the register is readonly, it can't be set more than once. */
4121 || RTX_UNCHANGING_P (x)
4122 /* Don't use hard regs to avoid extending their life. */
4123 || REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
4124 /* Avoid subtargets inside loops,
4125 since they hide some invariant expressions. */
4126 || preserve_subexpressions_p ())
4127 ? 0 : x);
4130 /* Expand an assignment that stores the value of FROM into TO.
4131 If WANT_VALUE is nonzero, return an rtx for the value of TO.
4132 (This may contain a QUEUED rtx;
4133 if the value is constant, this rtx is a constant.)
4134 Otherwise, the returned value is NULL_RTX. */
4137 expand_assignment (tree to, tree from, int want_value)
4139 rtx to_rtx = 0;
4140 rtx result;
4142 /* Don't crash if the lhs of the assignment was erroneous. */
4144 if (TREE_CODE (to) == ERROR_MARK)
4146 result = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
4147 return want_value ? result : NULL_RTX;
4150 /* Assignment of a structure component needs special treatment
4151 if the structure component's rtx is not simply a MEM.
4152 Assignment of an array element at a constant index, and assignment of
4153 an array element in an unaligned packed structure field, has the same
4154 problem. */
4156 if (TREE_CODE (to) == COMPONENT_REF || TREE_CODE (to) == BIT_FIELD_REF
4157 || TREE_CODE (to) == ARRAY_REF || TREE_CODE (to) == ARRAY_RANGE_REF
4158 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (to)) == ARRAY_TYPE)
4160 enum machine_mode mode1;
4161 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
4162 rtx orig_to_rtx;
4163 tree offset;
4164 int unsignedp;
4165 int volatilep = 0;
4166 tree tem;
4168 push_temp_slots ();
4169 tem = get_inner_reference (to, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode1,
4170 &unsignedp, &volatilep);
4172 /* If we are going to use store_bit_field and extract_bit_field,
4173 make sure to_rtx will be safe for multiple use. */
4175 if (mode1 == VOIDmode && want_value)
4176 tem = stabilize_reference (tem);
4178 orig_to_rtx = to_rtx = expand_expr (tem, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
4180 if (offset != 0)
4182 rtx offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_SUM);
4184 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) != MEM)
4185 abort ();
4187 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
4188 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != Pmode)
4189 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (Pmode, offset_rtx, 0);
4190 #else
4191 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != ptr_mode)
4192 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (ptr_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
4193 #endif
4195 /* A constant address in TO_RTX can have VOIDmode, we must not try
4196 to call force_reg for that case. Avoid that case. */
4197 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == MEM
4198 && GET_MODE (to_rtx) == BLKmode
4199 && GET_MODE (XEXP (to_rtx, 0)) != VOIDmode
4200 && bitsize > 0
4201 && (bitpos % bitsize) == 0
4202 && (bitsize % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)) == 0
4203 && MEM_ALIGN (to_rtx) == GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
4205 to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4206 bitpos = 0;
4209 to_rtx = offset_address (to_rtx, offset_rtx,
4210 highest_pow2_factor_for_type (TREE_TYPE (to),
4211 offset));
4214 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == MEM)
4216 /* If the field is at offset zero, we could have been given the
4217 DECL_RTX of the parent struct. Don't munge it. */
4218 to_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (to_rtx);
4220 set_mem_attributes_minus_bitpos (to_rtx, to, 0, bitpos);
4223 /* Deal with volatile and readonly fields. The former is only done
4224 for MEM. Also set MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P if needed. */
4225 if (volatilep && GET_CODE (to_rtx) == MEM)
4227 if (to_rtx == orig_to_rtx)
4228 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
4229 MEM_VOLATILE_P (to_rtx) = 1;
4232 if (TREE_CODE (to) == COMPONENT_REF
4233 && TREE_READONLY (TREE_OPERAND (to, 1)))
4235 if (to_rtx == orig_to_rtx)
4236 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
4237 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (to_rtx) = 1;
4240 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == MEM && ! can_address_p (to))
4242 if (to_rtx == orig_to_rtx)
4243 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
4244 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) = 1;
4247 result = store_field (to_rtx, bitsize, bitpos, mode1, from,
4248 (want_value
4249 /* Spurious cast for HPUX compiler. */
4250 ? ((enum machine_mode)
4251 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (to)))
4252 : VOIDmode),
4253 unsignedp, TREE_TYPE (tem), get_alias_set (to));
4255 preserve_temp_slots (result);
4256 free_temp_slots ();
4257 pop_temp_slots ();
4259 /* If the value is meaningful, convert RESULT to the proper mode.
4260 Otherwise, return nothing. */
4261 return (want_value ? convert_modes (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (to)),
4262 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from)),
4263 result,
4264 TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (to)))
4265 : NULL_RTX);
4268 /* If the rhs is a function call and its value is not an aggregate,
4269 call the function before we start to compute the lhs.
4270 This is needed for correct code for cases such as
4271 val = setjmp (buf) on machines where reference to val
4272 requires loading up part of an address in a separate insn.
4274 Don't do this if TO is a VAR_DECL or PARM_DECL whose DECL_RTL is REG
4275 since it might be a promoted variable where the zero- or sign- extension
4276 needs to be done. Handling this in the normal way is safe because no
4277 computation is done before the call. */
4278 if (TREE_CODE (from) == CALL_EXPR && ! aggregate_value_p (from)
4279 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (from))) == INTEGER_CST
4280 && ! ((TREE_CODE (to) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (to) == PARM_DECL)
4281 && GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (to)) == REG))
4283 rtx value;
4285 push_temp_slots ();
4286 value = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
4287 if (to_rtx == 0)
4288 to_rtx = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
4290 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
4291 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
4292 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL)
4293 emit_group_load (to_rtx, value, TREE_TYPE (from),
4294 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
4295 else if (GET_MODE (to_rtx) == BLKmode)
4296 emit_block_move (to_rtx, value, expr_size (from), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
4297 else
4299 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
4300 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (to))
4301 && GET_MODE (to_rtx) != GET_MODE (value))
4302 value = convert_memory_address (GET_MODE (to_rtx), value);
4303 #endif
4304 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, value);
4306 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
4307 free_temp_slots ();
4308 pop_temp_slots ();
4309 return want_value ? to_rtx : NULL_RTX;
4312 /* Ordinary treatment. Expand TO to get a REG or MEM rtx.
4313 Don't re-expand if it was expanded already (in COMPONENT_REF case). */
4315 if (to_rtx == 0)
4316 to_rtx = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
4318 /* Don't move directly into a return register. */
4319 if (TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL
4320 && (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == REG || GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL))
4322 rtx temp;
4324 push_temp_slots ();
4325 temp = expand_expr (from, 0, GET_MODE (to_rtx), 0);
4327 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL)
4328 emit_group_load (to_rtx, temp, TREE_TYPE (from),
4329 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
4330 else
4331 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, temp);
4333 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
4334 free_temp_slots ();
4335 pop_temp_slots ();
4336 return want_value ? to_rtx : NULL_RTX;
4339 /* In case we are returning the contents of an object which overlaps
4340 the place the value is being stored, use a safe function when copying
4341 a value through a pointer into a structure value return block. */
4342 if (TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL && TREE_CODE (from) == INDIRECT_REF
4343 && current_function_returns_struct
4344 && !current_function_returns_pcc_struct)
4346 rtx from_rtx, size;
4348 push_temp_slots ();
4349 size = expr_size (from);
4350 from_rtx = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
4352 if (TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS)
4353 emit_library_call (memmove_libfunc, LCT_NORMAL,
4354 VOIDmode, 3, XEXP (to_rtx, 0), Pmode,
4355 XEXP (from_rtx, 0), Pmode,
4356 convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
4357 size, TREE_UNSIGNED (sizetype)),
4358 TYPE_MODE (sizetype));
4359 else
4360 emit_library_call (bcopy_libfunc, LCT_NORMAL,
4361 VOIDmode, 3, XEXP (from_rtx, 0), Pmode,
4362 XEXP (to_rtx, 0), Pmode,
4363 convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node),
4364 size,
4365 TREE_UNSIGNED (integer_type_node)),
4366 TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node));
4368 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
4369 free_temp_slots ();
4370 pop_temp_slots ();
4371 return want_value ? to_rtx : NULL_RTX;
4374 /* Compute FROM and store the value in the rtx we got. */
4376 push_temp_slots ();
4377 result = store_expr (from, to_rtx, want_value);
4378 preserve_temp_slots (result);
4379 free_temp_slots ();
4380 pop_temp_slots ();
4381 return want_value ? result : NULL_RTX;
4384 /* Generate code for computing expression EXP,
4385 and storing the value into TARGET.
4386 TARGET may contain a QUEUED rtx.
4388 If WANT_VALUE & 1 is nonzero, return a copy of the value
4389 not in TARGET, so that we can be sure to use the proper
4390 value in a containing expression even if TARGET has something
4391 else stored in it. If possible, we copy the value through a pseudo
4392 and return that pseudo. Or, if the value is constant, we try to
4393 return the constant. In some cases, we return a pseudo
4394 copied *from* TARGET.
4396 If the mode is BLKmode then we may return TARGET itself.
4397 It turns out that in BLKmode it doesn't cause a problem.
4398 because C has no operators that could combine two different
4399 assignments into the same BLKmode object with different values
4400 with no sequence point. Will other languages need this to
4401 be more thorough?
4403 If WANT_VALUE & 1 is 0, we return NULL, to make sure
4404 to catch quickly any cases where the caller uses the value
4405 and fails to set WANT_VALUE.
4407 If WANT_VALUE & 2 is set, this is a store into a call param on the
4408 stack, and block moves may need to be treated specially. */
4411 store_expr (tree exp, rtx target, int want_value)
4413 rtx temp;
4414 int dont_return_target = 0;
4415 int dont_store_target = 0;
4417 if (VOID_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
4419 /* C++ can generate ?: expressions with a throw expression in one
4420 branch and an rvalue in the other. Here, we resolve attempts to
4421 store the throw expression's nonexistent result. */
4422 if (want_value)
4423 abort ();
4424 expand_expr (exp, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, 0);
4425 return NULL_RTX;
4427 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPOUND_EXPR)
4429 /* Perform first part of compound expression, then assign from second
4430 part. */
4431 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
4432 want_value & 2 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
4433 emit_queue ();
4434 return store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target, want_value);
4436 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COND_EXPR && GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode)
4438 /* For conditional expression, get safe form of the target. Then
4439 test the condition, doing the appropriate assignment on either
4440 side. This avoids the creation of unnecessary temporaries.
4441 For non-BLKmode, it is more efficient not to do this. */
4443 rtx lab1 = gen_label_rtx (), lab2 = gen_label_rtx ();
4445 emit_queue ();
4446 target = protect_from_queue (target, 1);
4448 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
4449 NO_DEFER_POP;
4450 jumpifnot (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), lab1);
4451 start_cleanup_deferral ();
4452 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target, want_value & 2);
4453 end_cleanup_deferral ();
4454 emit_queue ();
4455 emit_jump_insn (gen_jump (lab2));
4456 emit_barrier ();
4457 emit_label (lab1);
4458 start_cleanup_deferral ();
4459 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), target, want_value & 2);
4460 end_cleanup_deferral ();
4461 emit_queue ();
4462 emit_label (lab2);
4463 OK_DEFER_POP;
4465 return want_value & 1 ? target : NULL_RTX;
4467 else if (queued_subexp_p (target))
4468 /* If target contains a postincrement, let's not risk
4469 using it as the place to generate the rhs. */
4471 if (GET_MODE (target) != BLKmode && GET_MODE (target) != VOIDmode)
4473 /* Expand EXP into a new pseudo. */
4474 temp = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (target));
4475 temp = expand_expr (exp, temp, GET_MODE (target),
4476 (want_value & 2
4477 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL));
4479 else
4480 temp = expand_expr (exp, NULL_RTX, GET_MODE (target),
4481 (want_value & 2
4482 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL));
4484 /* If target is volatile, ANSI requires accessing the value
4485 *from* the target, if it is accessed. So make that happen.
4486 In no case return the target itself. */
4487 if (! MEM_VOLATILE_P (target) && (want_value & 1) != 0)
4488 dont_return_target = 1;
4490 else if ((want_value & 1) != 0
4491 && GET_CODE (target) == MEM
4492 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (target)
4493 && GET_MODE (target) != BLKmode)
4494 /* If target is in memory and caller wants value in a register instead,
4495 arrange that. Pass TARGET as target for expand_expr so that,
4496 if EXP is another assignment, WANT_VALUE will be nonzero for it.
4497 We know expand_expr will not use the target in that case.
4498 Don't do this if TARGET is volatile because we are supposed
4499 to write it and then read it. */
4501 temp = expand_expr (exp, target, GET_MODE (target),
4502 want_value & 2 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
4503 if (GET_MODE (temp) != BLKmode && GET_MODE (temp) != VOIDmode)
4505 /* If TEMP is already in the desired TARGET, only copy it from
4506 memory and don't store it there again. */
4507 if (temp == target
4508 || (rtx_equal_p (temp, target)
4509 && ! side_effects_p (temp) && ! side_effects_p (target)))
4510 dont_store_target = 1;
4511 temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
4513 dont_return_target = 1;
4515 else if (GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (target))
4516 /* If this is a scalar in a register that is stored in a wider mode
4517 than the declared mode, compute the result into its declared mode
4518 and then convert to the wider mode. Our value is the computed
4519 expression. */
4521 rtx inner_target = 0;
4523 /* If we don't want a value, we can do the conversion inside EXP,
4524 which will often result in some optimizations. Do the conversion
4525 in two steps: first change the signedness, if needed, then
4526 the extend. But don't do this if the type of EXP is a subtype
4527 of something else since then the conversion might involve
4528 more than just converting modes. */
4529 if ((want_value & 1) == 0
4530 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
4531 && TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == 0)
4533 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp))
4534 != SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target))
4535 exp = convert
4536 ((*lang_hooks.types.signed_or_unsigned_type)
4537 (SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target), TREE_TYPE (exp)), exp);
4539 exp = convert ((*lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode)
4540 (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (target)),
4541 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target)),
4542 exp);
4544 inner_target = SUBREG_REG (target);
4547 temp = expand_expr (exp, inner_target, VOIDmode,
4548 want_value & 2 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
4550 /* If TEMP is a MEM and we want a result value, make the access
4551 now so it gets done only once. Strictly speaking, this is
4552 only necessary if the MEM is volatile, or if the address
4553 overlaps TARGET. But not performing the load twice also
4554 reduces the amount of rtl we generate and then have to CSE. */
4555 if (GET_CODE (temp) == MEM && (want_value & 1) != 0)
4556 temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
4558 /* If TEMP is a VOIDmode constant, use convert_modes to make
4559 sure that we properly convert it. */
4560 if (CONSTANT_P (temp) && GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode)
4562 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (target), TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
4563 temp, SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
4564 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (target)),
4565 GET_MODE (target), temp,
4566 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
4569 convert_move (SUBREG_REG (target), temp,
4570 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
4572 /* If we promoted a constant, change the mode back down to match
4573 target. Otherwise, the caller might get confused by a result whose
4574 mode is larger than expected. */
4576 if ((want_value & 1) != 0 && GET_MODE (temp) != GET_MODE (target))
4578 if (GET_MODE (temp) != VOIDmode)
4580 temp = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (GET_MODE (target), temp);
4581 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (temp) = 1;
4582 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_SET (temp,
4583 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
4585 else
4586 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (target),
4587 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (target)),
4588 temp, SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
4591 return want_value & 1 ? temp : NULL_RTX;
4593 else
4595 temp = expand_expr (exp, target, GET_MODE (target),
4596 want_value & 2 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
4597 /* Return TARGET if it's a specified hardware register.
4598 If TARGET is a volatile mem ref, either return TARGET
4599 or return a reg copied *from* TARGET; ANSI requires this.
4601 Otherwise, if TEMP is not TARGET, return TEMP
4602 if it is constant (for efficiency),
4603 or if we really want the correct value. */
4604 if (!(target && GET_CODE (target) == REG
4605 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
4606 && !(GET_CODE (target) == MEM && MEM_VOLATILE_P (target))
4607 && ! rtx_equal_p (temp, target)
4608 && (CONSTANT_P (temp) || (want_value & 1) != 0))
4609 dont_return_target = 1;
4612 /* If TEMP is a VOIDmode constant and the mode of the type of EXP is not
4613 the same as that of TARGET, adjust the constant. This is needed, for
4614 example, in case it is a CONST_DOUBLE and we want only a word-sized
4615 value. */
4616 if (CONSTANT_P (temp) && GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode
4617 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ERROR_MARK
4618 && GET_MODE (target) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
4619 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (target), TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
4620 temp, TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
4622 /* If value was not generated in the target, store it there.
4623 Convert the value to TARGET's type first if necessary.
4624 If TEMP and TARGET compare equal according to rtx_equal_p, but
4625 one or both of them are volatile memory refs, we have to distinguish
4626 two cases:
4627 - expand_expr has used TARGET. In this case, we must not generate
4628 another copy. This can be detected by TARGET being equal according
4629 to == .
4630 - expand_expr has not used TARGET - that means that the source just
4631 happens to have the same RTX form. Since temp will have been created
4632 by expand_expr, it will compare unequal according to == .
4633 We must generate a copy in this case, to reach the correct number
4634 of volatile memory references. */
4636 if ((! rtx_equal_p (temp, target)
4637 || (temp != target && (side_effects_p (temp)
4638 || side_effects_p (target))))
4639 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ERROR_MARK
4640 && ! dont_store_target
4641 /* If store_expr stores a DECL whose DECL_RTL(exp) == TARGET,
4642 but TARGET is not valid memory reference, TEMP will differ
4643 from TARGET although it is really the same location. */
4644 && (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (exp)) != 'd'
4645 || target != DECL_RTL_IF_SET (exp))
4646 /* If there's nothing to copy, don't bother. Don't call expr_size
4647 unless necessary, because some front-ends (C++) expr_size-hook
4648 aborts on objects that are not supposed to be bit-copied or
4649 bit-initialized. */
4650 && expr_size (exp) != const0_rtx)
4652 target = protect_from_queue (target, 1);
4653 if (GET_MODE (temp) != GET_MODE (target)
4654 && GET_MODE (temp) != VOIDmode)
4656 int unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp));
4657 if (dont_return_target)
4659 /* In this case, we will return TEMP,
4660 so make sure it has the proper mode.
4661 But don't forget to store the value into TARGET. */
4662 temp = convert_to_mode (GET_MODE (target), temp, unsignedp);
4663 emit_move_insn (target, temp);
4665 else
4666 convert_move (target, temp, unsignedp);
4669 else if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode && TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST)
4671 /* Handle copying a string constant into an array. The string
4672 constant may be shorter than the array. So copy just the string's
4673 actual length, and clear the rest. First get the size of the data
4674 type of the string, which is actually the size of the target. */
4675 rtx size = expr_size (exp);
4677 if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
4678 && INTVAL (size) < TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp))
4679 emit_block_move (target, temp, size,
4680 (want_value & 2
4681 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
4682 else
4684 /* Compute the size of the data to copy from the string. */
4685 tree copy_size
4686 = size_binop (MIN_EXPR,
4687 make_tree (sizetype, size),
4688 size_int (TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp)));
4689 rtx copy_size_rtx
4690 = expand_expr (copy_size, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
4691 (want_value & 2
4692 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL));
4693 rtx label = 0;
4695 /* Copy that much. */
4696 copy_size_rtx = convert_to_mode (ptr_mode, copy_size_rtx,
4697 TREE_UNSIGNED (sizetype));
4698 emit_block_move (target, temp, copy_size_rtx,
4699 (want_value & 2
4700 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
4702 /* Figure out how much is left in TARGET that we have to clear.
4703 Do all calculations in ptr_mode. */
4704 if (GET_CODE (copy_size_rtx) == CONST_INT)
4706 size = plus_constant (size, -INTVAL (copy_size_rtx));
4707 target = adjust_address (target, BLKmode,
4708 INTVAL (copy_size_rtx));
4710 else
4712 size = expand_binop (TYPE_MODE (sizetype), sub_optab, size,
4713 copy_size_rtx, NULL_RTX, 0,
4714 OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
4716 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
4717 if (GET_MODE (copy_size_rtx) != Pmode)
4718 copy_size_rtx = convert_to_mode (Pmode, copy_size_rtx,
4719 TREE_UNSIGNED (sizetype));
4720 #endif
4722 target = offset_address (target, copy_size_rtx,
4723 highest_pow2_factor (copy_size));
4724 label = gen_label_rtx ();
4725 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (size, const0_rtx, LT, NULL_RTX,
4726 GET_MODE (size), 0, label);
4729 if (size != const0_rtx)
4730 clear_storage (target, size);
4732 if (label)
4733 emit_label (label);
4736 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
4737 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
4738 else if (GET_CODE (target) == PARALLEL)
4739 emit_group_load (target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp),
4740 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
4741 else if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode)
4742 emit_block_move (target, temp, expr_size (exp),
4743 (want_value & 2
4744 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
4745 else
4746 emit_move_insn (target, temp);
4749 /* If we don't want a value, return NULL_RTX. */
4750 if ((want_value & 1) == 0)
4751 return NULL_RTX;
4753 /* If we are supposed to return TEMP, do so as long as it isn't a MEM.
4754 ??? The latter test doesn't seem to make sense. */
4755 else if (dont_return_target && GET_CODE (temp) != MEM)
4756 return temp;
4758 /* Return TARGET itself if it is a hard register. */
4759 else if ((want_value & 1) != 0
4760 && GET_MODE (target) != BLKmode
4761 && ! (GET_CODE (target) == REG
4762 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
4763 return copy_to_reg (target);
4765 else
4766 return target;
4769 /* Return 1 if EXP just contains zeros. */
4771 static int
4772 is_zeros_p (tree exp)
4774 tree elt;
4776 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
4778 case CONVERT_EXPR:
4779 case NOP_EXPR:
4780 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
4781 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
4782 return is_zeros_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
4784 case INTEGER_CST:
4785 return integer_zerop (exp);
4787 case COMPLEX_CST:
4788 return
4789 is_zeros_p (TREE_REALPART (exp)) && is_zeros_p (TREE_IMAGPART (exp));
4791 case REAL_CST:
4792 return REAL_VALUES_IDENTICAL (TREE_REAL_CST (exp), dconst0);
4794 case VECTOR_CST:
4795 for (elt = TREE_VECTOR_CST_ELTS (exp); elt;
4796 elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt))
4797 if (!is_zeros_p (TREE_VALUE (elt)))
4798 return 0;
4800 return 1;
4802 case CONSTRUCTOR:
4803 if (TREE_TYPE (exp) && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == SET_TYPE)
4804 return CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp) == NULL_TREE;
4805 for (elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp); elt; elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt))
4806 if (! is_zeros_p (TREE_VALUE (elt)))
4807 return 0;
4809 return 1;
4811 default:
4812 return 0;
4816 /* Return 1 if EXP contains mostly (3/4) zeros. */
4818 static int
4819 mostly_zeros_p (tree exp)
4821 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
4823 int elts = 0, zeros = 0;
4824 tree elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp);
4825 if (TREE_TYPE (exp) && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == SET_TYPE)
4827 /* If there are no ranges of true bits, it is all zero. */
4828 return elt == NULL_TREE;
4830 for (; elt; elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt))
4832 /* We do not handle the case where the index is a RANGE_EXPR,
4833 so the statistic will be somewhat inaccurate.
4834 We do make a more accurate count in store_constructor itself,
4835 so since this function is only used for nested array elements,
4836 this should be close enough. */
4837 if (mostly_zeros_p (TREE_VALUE (elt)))
4838 zeros++;
4839 elts++;
4842 return 4 * zeros >= 3 * elts;
4845 return is_zeros_p (exp);
4848 /* Helper function for store_constructor.
4849 TARGET, BITSIZE, BITPOS, MODE, EXP are as for store_field.
4850 TYPE is the type of the CONSTRUCTOR, not the element type.
4851 CLEARED is as for store_constructor.
4852 ALIAS_SET is the alias set to use for any stores.
4854 This provides a recursive shortcut back to store_constructor when it isn't
4855 necessary to go through store_field. This is so that we can pass through
4856 the cleared field to let store_constructor know that we may not have to
4857 clear a substructure if the outer structure has already been cleared. */
4859 static void
4860 store_constructor_field (rtx target, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize,
4861 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, enum machine_mode mode,
4862 tree exp, tree type, int cleared, int alias_set)
4864 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR
4865 && bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0
4866 /* If we have a nonzero bitpos for a register target, then we just
4867 let store_field do the bitfield handling. This is unlikely to
4868 generate unnecessary clear instructions anyways. */
4869 && (bitpos == 0 || GET_CODE (target) == MEM))
4871 if (GET_CODE (target) == MEM)
4872 target
4873 = adjust_address (target,
4874 GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode
4875 || 0 != (bitpos
4876 % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (GET_MODE (target)))
4877 ? BLKmode : VOIDmode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4880 /* Update the alias set, if required. */
4881 if (GET_CODE (target) == MEM && ! MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
4882 && MEM_ALIAS_SET (target) != 0)
4884 target = copy_rtx (target);
4885 set_mem_alias_set (target, alias_set);
4888 store_constructor (exp, target, cleared, bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4890 else
4891 store_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, exp, VOIDmode, 0, type,
4892 alias_set);
4895 /* Store the value of constructor EXP into the rtx TARGET.
4896 TARGET is either a REG or a MEM; we know it cannot conflict, since
4897 safe_from_p has been called.
4898 CLEARED is true if TARGET is known to have been zero'd.
4899 SIZE is the number of bytes of TARGET we are allowed to modify: this
4900 may not be the same as the size of EXP if we are assigning to a field
4901 which has been packed to exclude padding bits. */
4903 static void
4904 store_constructor (tree exp, rtx target, int cleared, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
4906 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
4907 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
4908 HOST_WIDE_INT exp_size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
4909 #endif
4911 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE || TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE
4912 || TREE_CODE (type) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
4914 tree elt;
4916 /* If size is zero or the target is already cleared, do nothing. */
4917 if (size == 0 || cleared)
4918 cleared = 1;
4919 /* We either clear the aggregate or indicate the value is dead. */
4920 else if ((TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE
4921 || TREE_CODE (type) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
4922 && ! CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp))
4923 /* If the constructor is empty, clear the union. */
4925 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp));
4926 cleared = 1;
4929 /* If we are building a static constructor into a register,
4930 set the initial value as zero so we can fold the value into
4931 a constant. But if more than one register is involved,
4932 this probably loses. */
4933 else if (GET_CODE (target) == REG && TREE_STATIC (exp)
4934 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target)) <= UNITS_PER_WORD)
4936 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
4937 cleared = 1;
4940 /* If the constructor has fewer fields than the structure
4941 or if we are initializing the structure to mostly zeros,
4942 clear the whole structure first. Don't do this if TARGET is a
4943 register whose mode size isn't equal to SIZE since clear_storage
4944 can't handle this case. */
4945 else if (((list_length (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp)) != fields_length (type))
4946 || mostly_zeros_p (exp))
4947 && (GET_CODE (target) != REG
4948 || ((HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target))
4949 == size)))
4951 rtx xtarget = target;
4953 if (readonly_fields_p (type))
4955 xtarget = copy_rtx (xtarget);
4956 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (xtarget) = 1;
4959 clear_storage (xtarget, GEN_INT (size));
4960 cleared = 1;
4963 if (! cleared)
4964 emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, target));
4966 /* Store each element of the constructor into
4967 the corresponding field of TARGET. */
4969 for (elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp); elt; elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt))
4971 tree field = TREE_PURPOSE (elt);
4972 tree value = TREE_VALUE (elt);
4973 enum machine_mode mode;
4974 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
4975 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos = 0;
4976 tree offset;
4977 rtx to_rtx = target;
4979 /* Just ignore missing fields.
4980 We cleared the whole structure, above,
4981 if any fields are missing. */
4982 if (field == 0)
4983 continue;
4985 if (cleared && is_zeros_p (value))
4986 continue;
4988 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (field), 1))
4989 bitsize = tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (field), 1);
4990 else
4991 bitsize = -1;
4993 mode = DECL_MODE (field);
4994 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
4995 mode = VOIDmode;
4997 offset = DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field);
4998 if (host_integerp (offset, 0)
4999 && host_integerp (bit_position (field), 0))
5001 bitpos = int_bit_position (field);
5002 offset = 0;
5004 else
5005 bitpos = tree_low_cst (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field), 0);
5007 if (offset)
5009 rtx offset_rtx;
5011 if (CONTAINS_PLACEHOLDER_P (offset))
5012 offset = build (WITH_RECORD_EXPR, sizetype,
5013 offset, make_tree (TREE_TYPE (exp), target));
5015 offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
5016 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) != MEM)
5017 abort ();
5019 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
5020 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != Pmode)
5021 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (Pmode, offset_rtx, 0);
5022 #else
5023 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != ptr_mode)
5024 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (ptr_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
5025 #endif
5027 to_rtx = offset_address (to_rtx, offset_rtx,
5028 highest_pow2_factor (offset));
5031 if (TREE_READONLY (field))
5033 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == MEM)
5034 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
5036 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (to_rtx) = 1;
5039 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
5040 /* If this initializes a field that is smaller than a word, at the
5041 start of a word, try to widen it to a full word.
5042 This special case allows us to output C++ member function
5043 initializations in a form that the optimizers can understand. */
5044 if (GET_CODE (target) == REG
5045 && bitsize < BITS_PER_WORD
5046 && bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
5047 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5048 && TREE_CODE (value) == INTEGER_CST
5049 && exp_size >= 0
5050 && bitpos + BITS_PER_WORD <= exp_size * BITS_PER_UNIT)
5052 tree type = TREE_TYPE (value);
5054 if (TYPE_PRECISION (type) < BITS_PER_WORD)
5056 type = (*lang_hooks.types.type_for_size)
5057 (BITS_PER_WORD, TREE_UNSIGNED (type));
5058 value = convert (type, value);
5061 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
5062 value
5063 = fold (build (LSHIFT_EXPR, type, value,
5064 build_int_2 (BITS_PER_WORD - bitsize, 0)));
5065 bitsize = BITS_PER_WORD;
5066 mode = word_mode;
5068 #endif
5070 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == MEM && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx)
5071 && DECL_NONADDRESSABLE_P (field))
5073 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
5074 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) = 1;
5077 store_constructor_field (to_rtx, bitsize, bitpos, mode,
5078 value, type, cleared,
5079 get_alias_set (TREE_TYPE (field)));
5082 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
5083 || TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
5085 tree elt;
5086 int i;
5087 int need_to_clear;
5088 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
5089 tree elttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
5090 int const_bounds_p;
5091 HOST_WIDE_INT minelt = 0;
5092 HOST_WIDE_INT maxelt = 0;
5094 /* Vectors are like arrays, but the domain is stored via an array
5095 type indirectly. */
5096 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
5098 /* Note that although TYPE_DEBUG_REPRESENTATION_TYPE uses
5099 the same field as TYPE_DOMAIN, we are not guaranteed that
5100 it always will. */
5101 domain = TYPE_DEBUG_REPRESENTATION_TYPE (type);
5102 domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (TYPE_FIELDS (domain)));
5105 const_bounds_p = (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)
5106 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain)
5107 && host_integerp (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain), 0)
5108 && host_integerp (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain), 0));
5110 /* If we have constant bounds for the range of the type, get them. */
5111 if (const_bounds_p)
5113 minelt = tree_low_cst (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain), 0);
5114 maxelt = tree_low_cst (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain), 0);
5117 /* If the constructor has fewer elements than the array,
5118 clear the whole array first. Similarly if this is
5119 static constructor of a non-BLKmode object. */
5120 if (cleared || (GET_CODE (target) == REG && TREE_STATIC (exp)))
5121 need_to_clear = 1;
5122 else
5124 HOST_WIDE_INT count = 0, zero_count = 0;
5125 need_to_clear = ! const_bounds_p;
5127 /* This loop is a more accurate version of the loop in
5128 mostly_zeros_p (it handles RANGE_EXPR in an index).
5129 It is also needed to check for missing elements. */
5130 for (elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp);
5131 elt != NULL_TREE && ! need_to_clear;
5132 elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt))
5134 tree index = TREE_PURPOSE (elt);
5135 HOST_WIDE_INT this_node_count;
5137 if (index != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
5139 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 0);
5140 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 1);
5142 if (! host_integerp (lo_index, 1)
5143 || ! host_integerp (hi_index, 1))
5145 need_to_clear = 1;
5146 break;
5149 this_node_count = (tree_low_cst (hi_index, 1)
5150 - tree_low_cst (lo_index, 1) + 1);
5152 else
5153 this_node_count = 1;
5155 count += this_node_count;
5156 if (mostly_zeros_p (TREE_VALUE (elt)))
5157 zero_count += this_node_count;
5160 /* Clear the entire array first if there are any missing elements,
5161 or if the incidence of zero elements is >= 75%. */
5162 if (! need_to_clear
5163 && (count < maxelt - minelt + 1 || 4 * zero_count >= 3 * count))
5164 need_to_clear = 1;
5167 if (need_to_clear && size > 0)
5169 if (! cleared)
5171 if (REG_P (target))
5172 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
5173 else
5174 clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size));
5176 cleared = 1;
5178 else if (REG_P (target))
5179 /* Inform later passes that the old value is dead. */
5180 emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, target));
5182 /* Store each element of the constructor into
5183 the corresponding element of TARGET, determined
5184 by counting the elements. */
5185 for (elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), i = 0;
5186 elt;
5187 elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt), i++)
5189 enum machine_mode mode;
5190 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
5191 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos;
5192 int unsignedp;
5193 tree value = TREE_VALUE (elt);
5194 tree index = TREE_PURPOSE (elt);
5195 rtx xtarget = target;
5197 if (cleared && is_zeros_p (value))
5198 continue;
5200 unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (elttype);
5201 mode = TYPE_MODE (elttype);
5202 if (mode == BLKmode)
5203 bitsize = (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1)
5204 ? tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1)
5205 : -1);
5206 else
5207 bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
5209 if (index != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
5211 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 0);
5212 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 1);
5213 rtx index_r, pos_rtx, loop_end;
5214 struct nesting *loop;
5215 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi, count;
5216 tree position;
5218 /* If the range is constant and "small", unroll the loop. */
5219 if (const_bounds_p
5220 && host_integerp (lo_index, 0)
5221 && host_integerp (hi_index, 0)
5222 && (lo = tree_low_cst (lo_index, 0),
5223 hi = tree_low_cst (hi_index, 0),
5224 count = hi - lo + 1,
5225 (GET_CODE (target) != MEM
5226 || count <= 2
5227 || (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1)
5228 && (tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1) * count
5229 <= 40 * 8)))))
5231 lo -= minelt; hi -= minelt;
5232 for (; lo <= hi; lo++)
5234 bitpos = lo * tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 0);
5236 if (GET_CODE (target) == MEM
5237 && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
5238 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
5239 && TYPE_NONALIASED_COMPONENT (type))
5241 target = copy_rtx (target);
5242 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target) = 1;
5245 store_constructor_field
5246 (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, value, type, cleared,
5247 get_alias_set (elttype));
5250 else
5252 expand_expr (hi_index, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
5253 loop_end = gen_label_rtx ();
5255 unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (domain);
5257 index = build_decl (VAR_DECL, NULL_TREE, domain);
5259 index_r
5260 = gen_reg_rtx (promote_mode (domain, DECL_MODE (index),
5261 &unsignedp, 0));
5262 SET_DECL_RTL (index, index_r);
5263 if (TREE_CODE (value) == SAVE_EXPR
5264 && SAVE_EXPR_RTL (value) == 0)
5266 /* Make sure value gets expanded once before the
5267 loop. */
5268 expand_expr (value, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, 0);
5269 emit_queue ();
5271 store_expr (lo_index, index_r, 0);
5272 loop = expand_start_loop (0);
5274 /* Assign value to element index. */
5275 position
5276 = convert (ssizetype,
5277 fold (build (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (index),
5278 index, TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))));
5279 position = size_binop (MULT_EXPR, position,
5280 convert (ssizetype,
5281 TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elttype)));
5283 pos_rtx = expand_expr (position, 0, VOIDmode, 0);
5284 xtarget = offset_address (target, pos_rtx,
5285 highest_pow2_factor (position));
5286 xtarget = adjust_address (xtarget, mode, 0);
5287 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONSTRUCTOR)
5288 store_constructor (value, xtarget, cleared,
5289 bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5290 else
5291 store_expr (value, xtarget, 0);
5293 expand_exit_loop_if_false (loop,
5294 build (LT_EXPR, integer_type_node,
5295 index, hi_index));
5297 expand_increment (build (PREINCREMENT_EXPR,
5298 TREE_TYPE (index),
5299 index, integer_one_node), 0, 0);
5300 expand_end_loop ();
5301 emit_label (loop_end);
5304 else if ((index != 0 && ! host_integerp (index, 0))
5305 || ! host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1))
5307 tree position;
5309 if (index == 0)
5310 index = ssize_int (1);
5312 if (minelt)
5313 index = convert (ssizetype,
5314 fold (build (MINUS_EXPR, index,
5315 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))));
5317 position = size_binop (MULT_EXPR, index,
5318 convert (ssizetype,
5319 TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elttype)));
5320 xtarget = offset_address (target,
5321 expand_expr (position, 0, VOIDmode, 0),
5322 highest_pow2_factor (position));
5323 xtarget = adjust_address (xtarget, mode, 0);
5324 store_expr (value, xtarget, 0);
5326 else
5328 if (index != 0)
5329 bitpos = ((tree_low_cst (index, 0) - minelt)
5330 * tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1));
5331 else
5332 bitpos = (i * tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1));
5334 if (GET_CODE (target) == MEM && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
5335 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
5336 && TYPE_NONALIASED_COMPONENT (type))
5338 target = copy_rtx (target);
5339 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target) = 1;
5342 store_constructor_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, value,
5343 type, cleared, get_alias_set (elttype));
5349 /* Set constructor assignments. */
5350 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == SET_TYPE)
5352 tree elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp);
5353 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT nbytes = int_size_in_bytes (type), nbits;
5354 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
5355 tree domain_min, domain_max, bitlength;
5357 /* The default implementation strategy is to extract the constant
5358 parts of the constructor, use that to initialize the target,
5359 and then "or" in whatever non-constant ranges we need in addition.
5361 If a large set is all zero or all ones, it is
5362 probably better to set it using memset (if available) or bzero.
5363 Also, if a large set has just a single range, it may also be
5364 better to first clear all the first clear the set (using
5365 bzero/memset), and set the bits we want. */
5367 /* Check for all zeros. */
5368 if (elt == NULL_TREE && size > 0)
5370 if (!cleared)
5371 clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size));
5372 return;
5375 domain_min = convert (sizetype, TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain));
5376 domain_max = convert (sizetype, TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain));
5377 bitlength = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR,
5378 size_diffop (domain_max, domain_min),
5379 ssize_int (1));
5381 nbits = tree_low_cst (bitlength, 1);
5383 /* For "small" sets, or "medium-sized" (up to 32 bytes) sets that
5384 are "complicated" (more than one range), initialize (the
5385 constant parts) by copying from a constant. */
5386 if (GET_MODE (target) != BLKmode || nbits <= 2 * BITS_PER_WORD
5387 || (nbytes <= 32 && TREE_CHAIN (elt) != NULL_TREE))
5389 unsigned int set_word_size = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp));
5390 enum machine_mode mode = mode_for_size (set_word_size, MODE_INT, 1);
5391 char *bit_buffer = alloca (nbits);
5392 HOST_WIDE_INT word = 0;
5393 unsigned int bit_pos = 0;
5394 unsigned int ibit = 0;
5395 unsigned int offset = 0; /* In bytes from beginning of set. */
5397 elt = get_set_constructor_bits (exp, bit_buffer, nbits);
5398 for (;;)
5400 if (bit_buffer[ibit])
5402 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
5403 word |= (1 << (set_word_size - 1 - bit_pos));
5404 else
5405 word |= 1 << bit_pos;
5408 bit_pos++; ibit++;
5409 if (bit_pos >= set_word_size || ibit == nbits)
5411 if (word != 0 || ! cleared)
5413 rtx datum = GEN_INT (word);
5414 rtx to_rtx;
5416 /* The assumption here is that it is safe to use
5417 XEXP if the set is multi-word, but not if
5418 it's single-word. */
5419 if (GET_CODE (target) == MEM)
5420 to_rtx = adjust_address (target, mode, offset);
5421 else if (offset == 0)
5422 to_rtx = target;
5423 else
5424 abort ();
5425 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, datum);
5428 if (ibit == nbits)
5429 break;
5430 word = 0;
5431 bit_pos = 0;
5432 offset += set_word_size / BITS_PER_UNIT;
5436 else if (!cleared)
5437 /* Don't bother clearing storage if the set is all ones. */
5438 if (TREE_CHAIN (elt) != NULL_TREE
5439 || (TREE_PURPOSE (elt) == NULL_TREE
5440 ? nbits != 1
5441 : ( ! host_integerp (TREE_VALUE (elt), 0)
5442 || ! host_integerp (TREE_PURPOSE (elt), 0)
5443 || (tree_low_cst (TREE_VALUE (elt), 0)
5444 - tree_low_cst (TREE_PURPOSE (elt), 0) + 1
5445 != (HOST_WIDE_INT) nbits))))
5446 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp));
5448 for (; elt != NULL_TREE; elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt))
5450 /* Start of range of element or NULL. */
5451 tree startbit = TREE_PURPOSE (elt);
5452 /* End of range of element, or element value. */
5453 tree endbit = TREE_VALUE (elt);
5454 HOST_WIDE_INT startb, endb;
5455 rtx bitlength_rtx, startbit_rtx, endbit_rtx, targetx;
5457 bitlength_rtx = expand_expr (bitlength,
5458 NULL_RTX, MEM, EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS);
5460 /* Handle non-range tuple element like [ expr ]. */
5461 if (startbit == NULL_TREE)
5463 startbit = save_expr (endbit);
5464 endbit = startbit;
5467 startbit = convert (sizetype, startbit);
5468 endbit = convert (sizetype, endbit);
5469 if (! integer_zerop (domain_min))
5471 startbit = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR, startbit, domain_min);
5472 endbit = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR, endbit, domain_min);
5474 startbit_rtx = expand_expr (startbit, NULL_RTX, MEM,
5475 EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS);
5476 endbit_rtx = expand_expr (endbit, NULL_RTX, MEM,
5477 EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS);
5479 if (REG_P (target))
5481 targetx
5482 = assign_temp
5483 ((build_qualified_type ((*lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode)
5484 (GET_MODE (target), 0),
5485 TYPE_QUAL_CONST)),
5486 0, 1, 1);
5487 emit_move_insn (targetx, target);
5490 else if (GET_CODE (target) == MEM)
5491 targetx = target;
5492 else
5493 abort ();
5495 /* Optimization: If startbit and endbit are constants divisible
5496 by BITS_PER_UNIT, call memset instead. */
5497 if (TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
5498 && TREE_CODE (startbit) == INTEGER_CST
5499 && TREE_CODE (endbit) == INTEGER_CST
5500 && (startb = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (startbit)) % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0
5501 && (endb = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (endbit) + 1) % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0)
5503 emit_library_call (memset_libfunc, LCT_NORMAL,
5504 VOIDmode, 3,
5505 plus_constant (XEXP (targetx, 0),
5506 startb / BITS_PER_UNIT),
5507 Pmode,
5508 constm1_rtx, TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node),
5509 GEN_INT ((endb - startb) / BITS_PER_UNIT),
5510 TYPE_MODE (sizetype));
5512 else
5513 emit_library_call (setbits_libfunc, LCT_NORMAL,
5514 VOIDmode, 4, XEXP (targetx, 0),
5515 Pmode, bitlength_rtx, TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
5516 startbit_rtx, TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
5517 endbit_rtx, TYPE_MODE (sizetype));
5519 if (REG_P (target))
5520 emit_move_insn (target, targetx);
5524 else
5525 abort ();
5528 /* Store the value of EXP (an expression tree)
5529 into a subfield of TARGET which has mode MODE and occupies
5530 BITSIZE bits, starting BITPOS bits from the start of TARGET.
5531 If MODE is VOIDmode, it means that we are storing into a bit-field.
5533 If VALUE_MODE is VOIDmode, return nothing in particular.
5534 UNSIGNEDP is not used in this case.
5536 Otherwise, return an rtx for the value stored. This rtx
5537 has mode VALUE_MODE if that is convenient to do.
5538 In this case, UNSIGNEDP must be nonzero if the value is an unsigned type.
5540 TYPE is the type of the underlying object,
5542 ALIAS_SET is the alias set for the destination. This value will
5543 (in general) be different from that for TARGET, since TARGET is a
5544 reference to the containing structure. */
5546 static rtx
5547 store_field (rtx target, HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
5548 enum machine_mode mode, tree exp, enum machine_mode value_mode,
5549 int unsignedp, tree type, int alias_set)
5551 HOST_WIDE_INT width_mask = 0;
5553 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
5554 return const0_rtx;
5556 /* If we have nothing to store, do nothing unless the expression has
5557 side-effects. */
5558 if (bitsize == 0)
5559 return expand_expr (exp, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, 0);
5560 else if (bitsize >= 0 && bitsize < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
5561 width_mask = ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bitsize) - 1;
5563 /* If we are storing into an unaligned field of an aligned union that is
5564 in a register, we may have the mode of TARGET being an integer mode but
5565 MODE == BLKmode. In that case, get an aligned object whose size and
5566 alignment are the same as TARGET and store TARGET into it (we can avoid
5567 the store if the field being stored is the entire width of TARGET). Then
5568 call ourselves recursively to store the field into a BLKmode version of
5569 that object. Finally, load from the object into TARGET. This is not
5570 very efficient in general, but should only be slightly more expensive
5571 than the otherwise-required unaligned accesses. Perhaps this can be
5572 cleaned up later. It's tempting to make OBJECT readonly, but it's set
5573 twice, once with emit_move_insn and once via store_field. */
5575 if (mode == BLKmode
5576 && (GET_CODE (target) == REG || GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG))
5578 rtx object = assign_temp (type, 0, 1, 1);
5579 rtx blk_object = adjust_address (object, BLKmode, 0);
5581 if (bitsize != (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (target)))
5582 emit_move_insn (object, target);
5584 store_field (blk_object, bitsize, bitpos, mode, exp, VOIDmode, 0, type,
5585 alias_set);
5587 emit_move_insn (target, object);
5589 /* We want to return the BLKmode version of the data. */
5590 return blk_object;
5593 if (GET_CODE (target) == CONCAT)
5595 /* We're storing into a struct containing a single __complex. */
5597 if (bitpos != 0)
5598 abort ();
5599 return store_expr (exp, target, 0);
5602 /* If the structure is in a register or if the component
5603 is a bit field, we cannot use addressing to access it.
5604 Use bit-field techniques or SUBREG to store in it. */
5606 if (mode == VOIDmode
5607 || (mode != BLKmode && ! direct_store[(int) mode]
5608 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
5609 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT)
5610 || GET_CODE (target) == REG
5611 || GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG
5612 /* If the field isn't aligned enough to store as an ordinary memref,
5613 store it as a bit field. */
5614 || (mode != BLKmode
5615 && ((((MEM_ALIGN (target) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
5616 || bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
5617 && SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (target)))
5618 || (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)))
5619 /* If the RHS and field are a constant size and the size of the
5620 RHS isn't the same size as the bitfield, we must use bitfield
5621 operations. */
5622 || (bitsize >= 0
5623 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) == INTEGER_CST
5624 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), bitsize) != 0))
5626 rtx temp = expand_expr (exp, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
5628 /* If BITSIZE is narrower than the size of the type of EXP
5629 we will be narrowing TEMP. Normally, what's wanted are the
5630 low-order bits. However, if EXP's type is a record and this is
5631 big-endian machine, we want the upper BITSIZE bits. */
5632 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (temp)) == MODE_INT
5633 && bitsize < (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (temp))
5634 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == RECORD_TYPE)
5635 temp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (temp), temp,
5636 size_int (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (temp))
5637 - bitsize),
5638 NULL_RTX, 1);
5640 /* Unless MODE is VOIDmode or BLKmode, convert TEMP to
5641 MODE. */
5642 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode
5643 && mode != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
5644 temp = convert_modes (mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), temp, 1);
5646 /* If the modes of TARGET and TEMP are both BLKmode, both
5647 must be in memory and BITPOS must be aligned on a byte
5648 boundary. If so, we simply do a block copy. */
5649 if (GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode && GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode)
5651 if (GET_CODE (target) != MEM || GET_CODE (temp) != MEM
5652 || bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
5653 abort ();
5655 target = adjust_address (target, VOIDmode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5656 emit_block_move (target, temp,
5657 GEN_INT ((bitsize + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1)
5658 / BITS_PER_UNIT),
5659 BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5661 return value_mode == VOIDmode ? const0_rtx : target;
5664 /* Store the value in the bitfield. */
5665 store_bit_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, temp,
5666 int_size_in_bytes (type));
5668 if (value_mode != VOIDmode)
5670 /* The caller wants an rtx for the value.
5671 If possible, avoid refetching from the bitfield itself. */
5672 if (width_mask != 0
5673 && ! (GET_CODE (target) == MEM && MEM_VOLATILE_P (target)))
5675 tree count;
5676 enum machine_mode tmode;
5678 tmode = GET_MODE (temp);
5679 if (tmode == VOIDmode)
5680 tmode = value_mode;
5682 if (unsignedp)
5683 return expand_and (tmode, temp,
5684 gen_int_mode (width_mask, tmode),
5685 NULL_RTX);
5687 count = build_int_2 (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmode) - bitsize, 0);
5688 temp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, tmode, temp, count, 0, 0);
5689 return expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, tmode, temp, count, 0, 0);
5692 return extract_bit_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, unsignedp,
5693 NULL_RTX, value_mode, VOIDmode,
5694 int_size_in_bytes (type));
5696 return const0_rtx;
5698 else
5700 rtx addr = XEXP (target, 0);
5701 rtx to_rtx = target;
5703 /* If a value is wanted, it must be the lhs;
5704 so make the address stable for multiple use. */
5706 if (value_mode != VOIDmode && GET_CODE (addr) != REG
5707 && ! CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (addr)
5708 /* A frame-pointer reference is already stable. */
5709 && ! (GET_CODE (addr) == PLUS
5710 && GET_CODE (XEXP (addr, 1)) == CONST_INT
5711 && (XEXP (addr, 0) == virtual_incoming_args_rtx
5712 || XEXP (addr, 0) == virtual_stack_vars_rtx)))
5713 to_rtx = replace_equiv_address (to_rtx, copy_to_reg (addr));
5715 /* Now build a reference to just the desired component. */
5717 to_rtx = adjust_address (target, mode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5719 if (to_rtx == target)
5720 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
5722 MEM_SET_IN_STRUCT_P (to_rtx, 1);
5723 if (!MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) && MEM_ALIAS_SET (to_rtx) != 0)
5724 set_mem_alias_set (to_rtx, alias_set);
5726 return store_expr (exp, to_rtx, value_mode != VOIDmode);
5730 /* Given an expression EXP that may be a COMPONENT_REF, a BIT_FIELD_REF,
5731 an ARRAY_REF, or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF, look for nested operations of these
5732 codes and find the ultimate containing object, which we return.
5734 We set *PBITSIZE to the size in bits that we want, *PBITPOS to the
5735 bit position, and *PUNSIGNEDP to the signedness of the field.
5736 If the position of the field is variable, we store a tree
5737 giving the variable offset (in units) in *POFFSET.
5738 This offset is in addition to the bit position.
5739 If the position is not variable, we store 0 in *POFFSET.
5741 If any of the extraction expressions is volatile,
5742 we store 1 in *PVOLATILEP. Otherwise we don't change that.
5744 If the field is a bit-field, *PMODE is set to VOIDmode. Otherwise, it
5745 is a mode that can be used to access the field. In that case, *PBITSIZE
5746 is redundant.
5748 If the field describes a variable-sized object, *PMODE is set to
5749 VOIDmode and *PBITSIZE is set to -1. An access cannot be made in
5750 this case, but the address of the object can be found. */
5752 tree
5753 get_inner_reference (tree exp, HOST_WIDE_INT *pbitsize,
5754 HOST_WIDE_INT *pbitpos, tree *poffset,
5755 enum machine_mode *pmode, int *punsignedp,
5756 int *pvolatilep)
5758 tree size_tree = 0;
5759 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
5760 tree offset = size_zero_node;
5761 tree bit_offset = bitsize_zero_node;
5762 tree placeholder_ptr = 0;
5763 tree tem;
5765 /* First get the mode, signedness, and size. We do this from just the
5766 outermost expression. */
5767 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF)
5769 size_tree = DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
5770 if (! DECL_BIT_FIELD (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
5771 mode = DECL_MODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
5773 *punsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
5775 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == BIT_FIELD_REF)
5777 size_tree = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
5778 *punsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (exp);
5780 else
5782 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
5783 *punsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp));
5785 if (mode == BLKmode)
5786 size_tree = TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
5787 else
5788 *pbitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
5791 if (size_tree != 0)
5793 if (! host_integerp (size_tree, 1))
5794 mode = BLKmode, *pbitsize = -1;
5795 else
5796 *pbitsize = tree_low_cst (size_tree, 1);
5799 /* Compute cumulative bit-offset for nested component-refs and array-refs,
5800 and find the ultimate containing object. */
5801 while (1)
5803 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == BIT_FIELD_REF)
5804 bit_offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, bit_offset, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2));
5805 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF)
5807 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
5808 tree this_offset = DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field);
5810 /* If this field hasn't been filled in yet, don't go
5811 past it. This should only happen when folding expressions
5812 made during type construction. */
5813 if (this_offset == 0)
5814 break;
5815 else if (CONTAINS_PLACEHOLDER_P (this_offset))
5816 this_offset = build (WITH_RECORD_EXPR, sizetype, this_offset, exp);
5818 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset, this_offset);
5819 bit_offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, bit_offset,
5820 DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field));
5822 /* ??? Right now we don't do anything with DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN. */
5825 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ARRAY_REF
5826 || TREE_CODE (exp) == ARRAY_RANGE_REF)
5828 tree index = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
5829 tree array = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
5830 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (array));
5831 tree low_bound = (domain ? TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain) : 0);
5832 tree unit_size = TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (array)));
5834 /* We assume all arrays have sizes that are a multiple of a byte.
5835 First subtract the lower bound, if any, in the type of the
5836 index, then convert to sizetype and multiply by the size of the
5837 array element. */
5838 if (low_bound != 0 && ! integer_zerop (low_bound))
5839 index = fold (build (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (index),
5840 index, low_bound));
5842 /* If the index has a self-referential type, pass it to a
5843 WITH_RECORD_EXPR; if the component size is, pass our
5844 component to one. */
5845 if (CONTAINS_PLACEHOLDER_P (index))
5846 index = build (WITH_RECORD_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (index), index, exp);
5847 if (CONTAINS_PLACEHOLDER_P (unit_size))
5848 unit_size = build (WITH_RECORD_EXPR, sizetype, unit_size, array);
5850 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset,
5851 size_binop (MULT_EXPR,
5852 convert (sizetype, index),
5853 unit_size));
5856 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == PLACEHOLDER_EXPR)
5858 tree new = find_placeholder (exp, &placeholder_ptr);
5860 /* If we couldn't find the replacement, return the PLACEHOLDER_EXPR.
5861 We might have been called from tree optimization where we
5862 haven't set up an object yet. */
5863 if (new == 0)
5864 break;
5865 else
5866 exp = new;
5868 continue;
5871 /* We can go inside most conversions: all NON_VALUE_EXPRs, all normal
5872 conversions that don't change the mode, and all view conversions
5873 except those that need to "step up" the alignment. */
5874 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) != NON_LVALUE_EXPR
5875 && ! (TREE_CODE (exp) == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR
5876 && ! ((TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp))
5877 > TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))
5878 && STRICT_ALIGNMENT
5879 && (TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
5880 < BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT)
5881 && (TYPE_ALIGN_OK (TREE_TYPE (exp))
5882 || TYPE_ALIGN_OK (TREE_TYPE
5883 (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))))
5884 && ! ((TREE_CODE (exp) == NOP_EXPR
5885 || TREE_CODE (exp) == CONVERT_EXPR)
5886 && (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp))
5887 == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))))
5888 break;
5890 /* If any reference in the chain is volatile, the effect is volatile. */
5891 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp))
5892 *pvolatilep = 1;
5894 exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
5897 /* If OFFSET is constant, see if we can return the whole thing as a
5898 constant bit position. Otherwise, split it up. */
5899 if (host_integerp (offset, 0)
5900 && 0 != (tem = size_binop (MULT_EXPR, convert (bitsizetype, offset),
5901 bitsize_unit_node))
5902 && 0 != (tem = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, tem, bit_offset))
5903 && host_integerp (tem, 0))
5904 *pbitpos = tree_low_cst (tem, 0), *poffset = 0;
5905 else
5906 *pbitpos = tree_low_cst (bit_offset, 0), *poffset = offset;
5908 *pmode = mode;
5909 return exp;
5912 /* Return 1 if T is an expression that get_inner_reference handles. */
5915 handled_component_p (tree t)
5917 switch (TREE_CODE (t))
5919 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
5920 case COMPONENT_REF:
5921 case ARRAY_REF:
5922 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
5923 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
5924 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
5925 return 1;
5927 /* ??? Sure they are handled, but get_inner_reference may return
5928 a different PBITSIZE, depending upon whether the expression is
5929 wrapped up in a NOP_EXPR or not, e.g. for bitfields. */
5930 case NOP_EXPR:
5931 case CONVERT_EXPR:
5932 return (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (t))
5933 == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (t, 0))));
5935 default:
5936 return 0;
5940 /* Given an rtx VALUE that may contain additions and multiplications, return
5941 an equivalent value that just refers to a register, memory, or constant.
5942 This is done by generating instructions to perform the arithmetic and
5943 returning a pseudo-register containing the value.
5945 The returned value may be a REG, SUBREG, MEM or constant. */
5948 force_operand (rtx value, rtx target)
5950 rtx op1, op2;
5951 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
5952 rtx subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
5953 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (value);
5955 /* Check for a PIC address load. */
5956 if ((code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
5957 && XEXP (value, 0) == pic_offset_table_rtx
5958 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == SYMBOL_REF
5959 || GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == LABEL_REF
5960 || GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == CONST))
5962 if (!subtarget)
5963 subtarget = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (value));
5964 emit_move_insn (subtarget, value);
5965 return subtarget;
5968 if (code == ZERO_EXTEND || code == SIGN_EXTEND)
5970 if (!target)
5971 target = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (value));
5972 convert_move (target, force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), NULL),
5973 code == ZERO_EXTEND);
5974 return target;
5977 if (GET_RTX_CLASS (code) == '2' || GET_RTX_CLASS (code) == 'c')
5979 op2 = XEXP (value, 1);
5980 if (!CONSTANT_P (op2) && !(GET_CODE (op2) == REG && op2 != subtarget))
5981 subtarget = 0;
5982 if (code == MINUS && GET_CODE (op2) == CONST_INT)
5984 code = PLUS;
5985 op2 = negate_rtx (GET_MODE (value), op2);
5988 /* Check for an addition with OP2 a constant integer and our first
5989 operand a PLUS of a virtual register and something else. In that
5990 case, we want to emit the sum of the virtual register and the
5991 constant first and then add the other value. This allows virtual
5992 register instantiation to simply modify the constant rather than
5993 creating another one around this addition. */
5994 if (code == PLUS && GET_CODE (op2) == CONST_INT
5995 && GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 0)) == PLUS
5996 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)) == REG
5997 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)) >= FIRST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER
5998 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)) <= LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
6000 rtx temp = expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code,
6001 XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0), op2,
6002 subtarget, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
6003 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, temp,
6004 force_operand (XEXP (XEXP (value,
6005 0), 1), 0),
6006 target, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
6009 op1 = force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), subtarget);
6010 op2 = force_operand (op2, NULL_RTX);
6011 switch (code)
6013 case MULT:
6014 return expand_mult (GET_MODE (value), op1, op2, target, 1);
6015 case DIV:
6016 if (!INTEGRAL_MODE_P (GET_MODE (value)))
6017 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
6018 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
6019 else
6020 return expand_divmod (0,
6021 FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (value))
6022 ? RDIV_EXPR : TRUNC_DIV_EXPR,
6023 GET_MODE (value), op1, op2, target, 0);
6024 break;
6025 case MOD:
6026 return expand_divmod (1, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
6027 target, 0);
6028 break;
6029 case UDIV:
6030 return expand_divmod (0, TRUNC_DIV_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
6031 target, 1);
6032 break;
6033 case UMOD:
6034 return expand_divmod (1, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
6035 target, 1);
6036 break;
6037 case ASHIFTRT:
6038 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
6039 target, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
6040 break;
6041 default:
6042 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
6043 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
6046 if (GET_RTX_CLASS (code) == '1')
6048 op1 = force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), NULL_RTX);
6049 return expand_simple_unop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, target, 0);
6052 #ifdef INSN_SCHEDULING
6053 /* On machines that have insn scheduling, we want all memory reference to be
6054 explicit, so we need to deal with such paradoxical SUBREGs. */
6055 if (GET_CODE (value) == SUBREG && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (value)) == MEM
6056 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (value))
6057 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)))))
6058 value
6059 = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (value),
6060 force_reg (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
6061 force_operand (SUBREG_REG (value),
6062 NULL_RTX)),
6063 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
6064 SUBREG_BYTE (value));
6065 #endif
6067 return value;
6070 /* Subroutine of expand_expr: return nonzero iff there is no way that
6071 EXP can reference X, which is being modified. TOP_P is nonzero if this
6072 call is going to be used to determine whether we need a temporary
6073 for EXP, as opposed to a recursive call to this function.
6075 It is always safe for this routine to return zero since it merely
6076 searches for optimization opportunities. */
6079 safe_from_p (rtx x, tree exp, int top_p)
6081 rtx exp_rtl = 0;
6082 int i, nops;
6083 static tree save_expr_list;
6085 if (x == 0
6086 /* If EXP has varying size, we MUST use a target since we currently
6087 have no way of allocating temporaries of variable size
6088 (except for arrays that have TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE set).
6089 So we assume here that something at a higher level has prevented a
6090 clash. This is somewhat bogus, but the best we can do. Only
6091 do this when X is BLKmode and when we are at the top level. */
6092 || (top_p && TREE_TYPE (exp) != 0 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
6093 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) != INTEGER_CST
6094 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) != ARRAY_TYPE
6095 || TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == NULL_TREE
6096 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
6097 != INTEGER_CST)
6098 && GET_MODE (x) == BLKmode)
6099 /* If X is in the outgoing argument area, it is always safe. */
6100 || (GET_CODE (x) == MEM
6101 && (XEXP (x, 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx
6102 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
6103 && XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx))))
6104 return 1;
6106 /* If this is a subreg of a hard register, declare it unsafe, otherwise,
6107 find the underlying pseudo. */
6108 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
6110 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
6111 if (GET_CODE (x) == REG && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6112 return 0;
6115 /* A SAVE_EXPR might appear many times in the expression passed to the
6116 top-level safe_from_p call, and if it has a complex subexpression,
6117 examining it multiple times could result in a combinatorial explosion.
6118 E.g. on an Alpha running at least 200MHz, a Fortran test case compiled
6119 with optimization took about 28 minutes to compile -- even though it was
6120 only a few lines long. So we mark each SAVE_EXPR we see with TREE_PRIVATE
6121 and turn that off when we are done. We keep a list of the SAVE_EXPRs
6122 we have processed. Note that the only test of top_p was above. */
6124 if (top_p)
6126 int rtn;
6127 tree t;
6129 save_expr_list = 0;
6131 rtn = safe_from_p (x, exp, 0);
6133 for (t = save_expr_list; t != 0; t = TREE_CHAIN (t))
6134 TREE_PRIVATE (TREE_PURPOSE (t)) = 0;
6136 return rtn;
6139 /* Now look at our tree code and possibly recurse. */
6140 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (exp)))
6142 case 'd':
6143 exp_rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (exp);
6144 break;
6146 case 'c':
6147 return 1;
6149 case 'x':
6150 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == TREE_LIST)
6152 while (1)
6154 if (TREE_VALUE (exp) && !safe_from_p (x, TREE_VALUE (exp), 0))
6155 return 0;
6156 exp = TREE_CHAIN (exp);
6157 if (!exp)
6158 return 1;
6159 if (TREE_CODE (exp) != TREE_LIST)
6160 return safe_from_p (x, exp, 0);
6163 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
6164 return 1; /* An already-visited SAVE_EXPR? */
6165 else
6166 return 0;
6168 case '2':
6169 case '<':
6170 if (!safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0))
6171 return 0;
6172 /* FALLTHRU */
6174 case '1':
6175 return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
6177 case 'e':
6178 case 'r':
6179 /* Now do code-specific tests. EXP_RTL is set to any rtx we find in
6180 the expression. If it is set, we conflict iff we are that rtx or
6181 both are in memory. Otherwise, we check all operands of the
6182 expression recursively. */
6184 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
6186 case ADDR_EXPR:
6187 /* If the operand is static or we are static, we can't conflict.
6188 Likewise if we don't conflict with the operand at all. */
6189 if (staticp (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
6190 || TREE_STATIC (exp)
6191 || safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
6192 return 1;
6194 /* Otherwise, the only way this can conflict is if we are taking
6195 the address of a DECL a that address if part of X, which is
6196 very rare. */
6197 exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
6198 if (DECL_P (exp))
6200 if (!DECL_RTL_SET_P (exp)
6201 || GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (exp)) != MEM)
6202 return 0;
6203 else
6204 exp_rtl = XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0);
6206 break;
6208 case INDIRECT_REF:
6209 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM
6210 && alias_sets_conflict_p (MEM_ALIAS_SET (x),
6211 get_alias_set (exp)))
6212 return 0;
6213 break;
6215 case CALL_EXPR:
6216 /* Assume that the call will clobber all hard registers and
6217 all of memory. */
6218 if ((GET_CODE (x) == REG && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6219 || GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
6220 return 0;
6221 break;
6223 case RTL_EXPR:
6224 /* If a sequence exists, we would have to scan every instruction
6225 in the sequence to see if it was safe. This is probably not
6226 worthwhile. */
6227 if (RTL_EXPR_SEQUENCE (exp))
6228 return 0;
6230 exp_rtl = RTL_EXPR_RTL (exp);
6231 break;
6233 case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
6234 exp_rtl = WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR_RTL (exp);
6235 break;
6237 case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
6238 return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
6240 case SAVE_EXPR:
6241 exp_rtl = SAVE_EXPR_RTL (exp);
6242 if (exp_rtl)
6243 break;
6245 /* If we've already scanned this, don't do it again. Otherwise,
6246 show we've scanned it and record for clearing the flag if we're
6247 going on. */
6248 if (TREE_PRIVATE (exp))
6249 return 1;
6251 TREE_PRIVATE (exp) = 1;
6252 if (! safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
6254 TREE_PRIVATE (exp) = 0;
6255 return 0;
6258 save_expr_list = tree_cons (exp, NULL_TREE, save_expr_list);
6259 return 1;
6261 case BIND_EXPR:
6262 /* The only operand we look at is operand 1. The rest aren't
6263 part of the expression. */
6264 return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0);
6266 default:
6267 break;
6270 /* If we have an rtx, we do not need to scan our operands. */
6271 if (exp_rtl)
6272 break;
6274 nops = first_rtl_op (TREE_CODE (exp));
6275 for (i = 0; i < nops; i++)
6276 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, i) != 0
6277 && ! safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, i), 0))
6278 return 0;
6280 /* If this is a language-specific tree code, it may require
6281 special handling. */
6282 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (exp)
6283 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE
6284 && !(*lang_hooks.safe_from_p) (x, exp))
6285 return 0;
6288 /* If we have an rtl, find any enclosed object. Then see if we conflict
6289 with it. */
6290 if (exp_rtl)
6292 if (GET_CODE (exp_rtl) == SUBREG)
6294 exp_rtl = SUBREG_REG (exp_rtl);
6295 if (GET_CODE (exp_rtl) == REG
6296 && REGNO (exp_rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6297 return 0;
6300 /* If the rtl is X, then it is not safe. Otherwise, it is unless both
6301 are memory and they conflict. */
6302 return ! (rtx_equal_p (x, exp_rtl)
6303 || (GET_CODE (x) == MEM && GET_CODE (exp_rtl) == MEM
6304 && true_dependence (exp_rtl, VOIDmode, x,
6305 rtx_addr_varies_p)));
6308 /* If we reach here, it is safe. */
6309 return 1;
6312 /* Subroutine of expand_expr: return rtx if EXP is a
6313 variable or parameter; else return 0. */
6315 static rtx
6316 var_rtx (tree exp)
6318 STRIP_NOPS (exp);
6319 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
6321 case PARM_DECL:
6322 case VAR_DECL:
6323 return DECL_RTL (exp);
6324 default:
6325 return 0;
6329 #ifdef MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE
6331 void
6332 check_max_integer_computation_mode (tree exp)
6334 enum tree_code code;
6335 enum machine_mode mode;
6337 /* Strip any NOPs that don't change the mode. */
6338 STRIP_NOPS (exp);
6339 code = TREE_CODE (exp);
6341 /* We must allow conversions of constants to MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE. */
6342 if (code == NOP_EXPR
6343 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == INTEGER_CST)
6344 return;
6346 /* First check the type of the overall operation. We need only look at
6347 unary, binary and relational operations. */
6348 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == '1'
6349 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == '2'
6350 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == '<')
6352 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6353 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
6354 && mode > MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE)
6355 internal_error ("unsupported wide integer operation");
6358 /* Check operand of a unary op. */
6359 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == '1')
6361 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
6362 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
6363 && mode > MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE)
6364 internal_error ("unsupported wide integer operation");
6367 /* Check operands of a binary/comparison op. */
6368 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == '2' || TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == '<')
6370 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
6371 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
6372 && mode > MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE)
6373 internal_error ("unsupported wide integer operation");
6375 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)));
6376 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
6377 && mode > MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE)
6378 internal_error ("unsupported wide integer operation");
6381 #endif
6383 /* Return the highest power of two that EXP is known to be a multiple of.
6384 This is used in updating alignment of MEMs in array references. */
6386 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
6387 highest_pow2_factor (tree exp)
6389 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT c0, c1;
6391 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
6393 case INTEGER_CST:
6394 /* We can find the lowest bit that's a one. If the low
6395 HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT bits are zero, return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT.
6396 We need to handle this case since we can find it in a COND_EXPR,
6397 a MIN_EXPR, or a MAX_EXPR. If the constant overlows, we have an
6398 erroneous program, so return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT to avoid any
6399 later ICE. */
6400 if (TREE_CONSTANT_OVERFLOW (exp))
6401 return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
6402 else
6404 /* Note: tree_low_cst is intentionally not used here,
6405 we don't care about the upper bits. */
6406 c0 = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (exp);
6407 c0 &= -c0;
6408 return c0 ? c0 : BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
6410 break;
6412 case PLUS_EXPR: case MINUS_EXPR: case MIN_EXPR: case MAX_EXPR:
6413 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
6414 c1 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
6415 return MIN (c0, c1);
6417 case MULT_EXPR:
6418 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
6419 c1 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
6420 return c0 * c1;
6422 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR: case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR: case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
6423 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
6424 if (integer_pow2p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
6425 && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
6427 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
6428 c1 = tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1);
6429 return MAX (1, c0 / c1);
6431 break;
6433 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR: case NOP_EXPR: case CONVERT_EXPR:
6434 case SAVE_EXPR: case WITH_RECORD_EXPR:
6435 return highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
6437 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
6438 return highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
6440 case COND_EXPR:
6441 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
6442 c1 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2));
6443 return MIN (c0, c1);
6445 default:
6446 break;
6449 return 1;
6452 /* Similar, except that it is known that the expression must be a multiple
6453 of the alignment of TYPE. */
6455 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
6456 highest_pow2_factor_for_type (tree type, tree exp)
6458 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT type_align, factor;
6460 factor = highest_pow2_factor (exp);
6461 type_align = TYPE_ALIGN (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
6462 return MAX (factor, type_align);
6465 /* Return an object on the placeholder list that matches EXP, a
6466 PLACEHOLDER_EXPR. An object "matches" if it is of the type of the
6467 PLACEHOLDER_EXPR or a pointer type to it. For further information, see
6468 tree.def. If no such object is found, return 0. If PLIST is nonzero, it
6469 is a location which initially points to a starting location in the
6470 placeholder list (zero means start of the list) and where a pointer into
6471 the placeholder list at which the object is found is placed. */
6473 tree
6474 find_placeholder (tree exp, tree *plist)
6476 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
6477 tree placeholder_expr;
6479 for (placeholder_expr
6480 = plist && *plist ? TREE_CHAIN (*plist) : placeholder_list;
6481 placeholder_expr != 0;
6482 placeholder_expr = TREE_CHAIN (placeholder_expr))
6484 tree need_type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
6485 tree elt;
6487 /* Find the outermost reference that is of the type we want. If none,
6488 see if any object has a type that is a pointer to the type we
6489 want. */
6490 for (elt = TREE_PURPOSE (placeholder_expr); elt != 0;
6491 elt = ((TREE_CODE (elt) == COMPOUND_EXPR
6492 || TREE_CODE (elt) == COND_EXPR)
6493 ? TREE_OPERAND (elt, 1)
6494 : (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (elt)) == 'r'
6495 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (elt)) == '1'
6496 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (elt)) == '2'
6497 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (elt)) == 'e')
6498 ? TREE_OPERAND (elt, 0) : 0))
6499 if (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (TREE_TYPE (elt)) == need_type)
6501 if (plist)
6502 *plist = placeholder_expr;
6503 return elt;
6506 for (elt = TREE_PURPOSE (placeholder_expr); elt != 0;
6508 = ((TREE_CODE (elt) == COMPOUND_EXPR
6509 || TREE_CODE (elt) == COND_EXPR)
6510 ? TREE_OPERAND (elt, 1)
6511 : (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (elt)) == 'r'
6512 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (elt)) == '1'
6513 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (elt)) == '2'
6514 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (elt)) == 'e')
6515 ? TREE_OPERAND (elt, 0) : 0))
6516 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (elt))
6517 && (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (elt)))
6518 == need_type))
6520 if (plist)
6521 *plist = placeholder_expr;
6522 return build1 (INDIRECT_REF, need_type, elt);
6526 return 0;
6529 /* expand_expr: generate code for computing expression EXP.
6530 An rtx for the computed value is returned. The value is never null.
6531 In the case of a void EXP, const0_rtx is returned.
6533 The value may be stored in TARGET if TARGET is nonzero.
6534 TARGET is just a suggestion; callers must assume that
6535 the rtx returned may not be the same as TARGET.
6537 If TARGET is CONST0_RTX, it means that the value will be ignored.
6539 If TMODE is not VOIDmode, it suggests generating the
6540 result in mode TMODE. But this is done only when convenient.
6541 Otherwise, TMODE is ignored and the value generated in its natural mode.
6542 TMODE is just a suggestion; callers must assume that
6543 the rtx returned may not have mode TMODE.
6545 Note that TARGET may have neither TMODE nor MODE. In that case, it
6546 probably will not be used.
6548 If MODIFIER is EXPAND_SUM then when EXP is an addition
6549 we can return an rtx of the form (MULT (REG ...) (CONST_INT ...))
6550 or a nest of (PLUS ...) and (MINUS ...) where the terms are
6551 products as above, or REG or MEM, or constant.
6552 Ordinarily in such cases we would output mul or add instructions
6553 and then return a pseudo reg containing the sum.
6555 EXPAND_INITIALIZER is much like EXPAND_SUM except that
6556 it also marks a label as absolutely required (it can't be dead).
6557 It also makes a ZERO_EXTEND or SIGN_EXTEND instead of emitting extend insns.
6558 This is used for outputting expressions used in initializers.
6560 EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS says that it is okay to return a MEM
6561 with a constant address even if that address is not normally legitimate.
6562 EXPAND_INITIALIZER and EXPAND_SUM also have this effect.
6564 EXPAND_STACK_PARM is used when expanding to a TARGET on the stack for
6565 a call parameter. Such targets require special care as we haven't yet
6566 marked TARGET so that it's safe from being trashed by libcalls. We
6567 don't want to use TARGET for anything but the final result;
6568 Intermediate values must go elsewhere. Additionally, calls to
6569 emit_block_move will be flagged with BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM. */
6572 expand_expr (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode, enum expand_modifier modifier)
6574 rtx op0, op1, temp;
6575 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
6576 int unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (type);
6577 enum machine_mode mode;
6578 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (exp);
6579 optab this_optab;
6580 rtx subtarget, original_target;
6581 int ignore;
6582 tree context;
6584 /* Handle ERROR_MARK before anybody tries to access its type. */
6585 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
6587 op0 = CONST0_RTX (tmode);
6588 if (op0 != 0)
6589 return op0;
6590 return const0_rtx;
6593 mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
6594 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
6595 subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
6596 original_target = target;
6597 ignore = (target == const0_rtx
6598 || ((code == NON_LVALUE_EXPR || code == NOP_EXPR
6599 || code == CONVERT_EXPR || code == REFERENCE_EXPR
6600 || code == COND_EXPR || code == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR)
6601 && TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE));
6603 /* If we are going to ignore this result, we need only do something
6604 if there is a side-effect somewhere in the expression. If there
6605 is, short-circuit the most common cases here. Note that we must
6606 not call expand_expr with anything but const0_rtx in case this
6607 is an initial expansion of a size that contains a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR. */
6609 if (ignore)
6611 if (! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (exp))
6612 return const0_rtx;
6614 /* Ensure we reference a volatile object even if value is ignored, but
6615 don't do this if all we are doing is taking its address. */
6616 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp)
6617 && TREE_CODE (exp) != FUNCTION_DECL
6618 && mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode
6619 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
6621 temp = expand_expr (exp, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
6622 if (GET_CODE (temp) == MEM)
6623 temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
6624 return const0_rtx;
6627 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == '1' || code == COMPONENT_REF
6628 || code == INDIRECT_REF || code == BUFFER_REF)
6629 return expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
6630 modifier);
6632 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == '2' || TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == '<'
6633 || code == ARRAY_REF || code == ARRAY_RANGE_REF)
6635 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
6636 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
6637 return const0_rtx;
6639 else if ((code == TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR || code == TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR)
6640 && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
6641 /* If the second operand has no side effects, just evaluate
6642 the first. */
6643 return expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
6644 modifier);
6645 else if (code == BIT_FIELD_REF)
6647 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
6648 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
6649 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
6650 return const0_rtx;
6653 target = 0;
6656 #ifdef MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE
6657 /* Only check stuff here if the mode we want is different from the mode
6658 of the expression; if it's the same, check_max_integer_computation_mode
6659 will handle it. Do we really need to check this stuff at all? */
6661 if (target
6662 && GET_MODE (target) != mode
6663 && TREE_CODE (exp) != INTEGER_CST
6664 && TREE_CODE (exp) != PARM_DECL
6665 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ARRAY_REF
6666 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ARRAY_RANGE_REF
6667 && TREE_CODE (exp) != COMPONENT_REF
6668 && TREE_CODE (exp) != BIT_FIELD_REF
6669 && TREE_CODE (exp) != INDIRECT_REF
6670 && TREE_CODE (exp) != CALL_EXPR
6671 && TREE_CODE (exp) != VAR_DECL
6672 && TREE_CODE (exp) != RTL_EXPR)
6674 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (target);
6676 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
6677 && mode > MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE)
6678 internal_error ("unsupported wide integer operation");
6681 if (tmode != mode
6682 && TREE_CODE (exp) != INTEGER_CST
6683 && TREE_CODE (exp) != PARM_DECL
6684 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ARRAY_REF
6685 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ARRAY_RANGE_REF
6686 && TREE_CODE (exp) != COMPONENT_REF
6687 && TREE_CODE (exp) != BIT_FIELD_REF
6688 && TREE_CODE (exp) != INDIRECT_REF
6689 && TREE_CODE (exp) != VAR_DECL
6690 && TREE_CODE (exp) != CALL_EXPR
6691 && TREE_CODE (exp) != RTL_EXPR
6692 && GET_MODE_CLASS (tmode) == MODE_INT
6693 && tmode > MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE)
6694 internal_error ("unsupported wide integer operation");
6696 check_max_integer_computation_mode (exp);
6697 #endif
6699 /* If will do cse, generate all results into pseudo registers
6700 since 1) that allows cse to find more things
6701 and 2) otherwise cse could produce an insn the machine
6702 cannot support. An exception is a CONSTRUCTOR into a multi-word
6703 MEM: that's much more likely to be most efficient into the MEM.
6704 Another is a CALL_EXPR which must return in memory. */
6706 if (! cse_not_expected && mode != BLKmode && target
6707 && (GET_CODE (target) != REG || REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6708 && ! (code == CONSTRUCTOR && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > UNITS_PER_WORD)
6709 && ! (code == CALL_EXPR && aggregate_value_p (exp)))
6710 target = 0;
6712 switch (code)
6714 case LABEL_DECL:
6716 tree function = decl_function_context (exp);
6717 /* Labels in containing functions, or labels used from initializers,
6718 must be forced. */
6719 if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
6720 || (function != current_function_decl
6721 && function != inline_function_decl
6722 && function != 0))
6723 temp = force_label_rtx (exp);
6724 else
6725 temp = label_rtx (exp);
6727 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (FUNCTION_MODE, gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, temp));
6728 if (function != current_function_decl
6729 && function != inline_function_decl && function != 0)
6730 LABEL_REF_NONLOCAL_P (XEXP (temp, 0)) = 1;
6731 return temp;
6734 case PARM_DECL:
6735 if (!DECL_RTL_SET_P (exp))
6737 error ("%Hprior parameter's size depends on '%D'",
6738 &DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (exp), exp);
6739 return CONST0_RTX (mode);
6742 /* ... fall through ... */
6744 case VAR_DECL:
6745 /* If a static var's type was incomplete when the decl was written,
6746 but the type is complete now, lay out the decl now. */
6747 if (DECL_SIZE (exp) == 0
6748 && COMPLETE_OR_UNBOUND_ARRAY_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
6749 && (TREE_STATIC (exp) || DECL_EXTERNAL (exp)))
6750 layout_decl (exp, 0);
6752 /* ... fall through ... */
6754 case FUNCTION_DECL:
6755 case RESULT_DECL:
6756 if (DECL_RTL (exp) == 0)
6757 abort ();
6759 /* Ensure variable marked as used even if it doesn't go through
6760 a parser. If it hasn't be used yet, write out an external
6761 definition. */
6762 if (! TREE_USED (exp))
6764 assemble_external (exp);
6765 TREE_USED (exp) = 1;
6768 /* Show we haven't gotten RTL for this yet. */
6769 temp = 0;
6771 /* Handle variables inherited from containing functions. */
6772 context = decl_function_context (exp);
6774 /* We treat inline_function_decl as an alias for the current function
6775 because that is the inline function whose vars, types, etc.
6776 are being merged into the current function.
6777 See expand_inline_function. */
6779 if (context != 0 && context != current_function_decl
6780 && context != inline_function_decl
6781 /* If var is static, we don't need a static chain to access it. */
6782 && ! (GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (exp)) == MEM
6783 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0))))
6785 rtx addr;
6787 /* Mark as non-local and addressable. */
6788 DECL_NONLOCAL (exp) = 1;
6789 if (DECL_NO_STATIC_CHAIN (current_function_decl))
6790 abort ();
6791 (*lang_hooks.mark_addressable) (exp);
6792 if (GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (exp)) != MEM)
6793 abort ();
6794 addr = XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0);
6795 if (GET_CODE (addr) == MEM)
6796 addr
6797 = replace_equiv_address (addr,
6798 fix_lexical_addr (XEXP (addr, 0), exp));
6799 else
6800 addr = fix_lexical_addr (addr, exp);
6802 temp = replace_equiv_address (DECL_RTL (exp), addr);
6805 /* This is the case of an array whose size is to be determined
6806 from its initializer, while the initializer is still being parsed.
6807 See expand_decl. */
6809 else if (GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (exp)) == MEM
6810 && GET_CODE (XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0)) == REG)
6811 temp = validize_mem (DECL_RTL (exp));
6813 /* If DECL_RTL is memory, we are in the normal case and either
6814 the address is not valid or it is not a register and -fforce-addr
6815 is specified, get the address into a register. */
6817 else if (GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (exp)) == MEM
6818 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
6819 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
6820 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
6821 && (! memory_address_p (DECL_MODE (exp),
6822 XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0))
6823 || (flag_force_addr
6824 && GET_CODE (XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0)) != REG)))
6825 temp = replace_equiv_address (DECL_RTL (exp),
6826 copy_rtx (XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0)));
6828 /* If we got something, return it. But first, set the alignment
6829 if the address is a register. */
6830 if (temp != 0)
6832 if (GET_CODE (temp) == MEM && GET_CODE (XEXP (temp, 0)) == REG)
6833 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (temp, 0), DECL_ALIGN (exp));
6835 return temp;
6838 /* If the mode of DECL_RTL does not match that of the decl, it
6839 must be a promoted value. We return a SUBREG of the wanted mode,
6840 but mark it so that we know that it was already extended. */
6842 if (GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (exp)) == REG
6843 && GET_MODE (DECL_RTL (exp)) != DECL_MODE (exp))
6845 /* Get the signedness used for this variable. Ensure we get the
6846 same mode we got when the variable was declared. */
6847 if (GET_MODE (DECL_RTL (exp))
6848 != promote_mode (type, DECL_MODE (exp), &unsignedp,
6849 (TREE_CODE (exp) == RESULT_DECL ? 1 : 0)))
6850 abort ();
6852 temp = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (mode, DECL_RTL (exp));
6853 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (temp) = 1;
6854 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_SET (temp, unsignedp);
6855 return temp;
6858 return DECL_RTL (exp);
6860 case INTEGER_CST:
6861 temp = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (exp),
6862 TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (exp), mode);
6864 /* ??? If overflow is set, fold will have done an incomplete job,
6865 which can result in (plus xx (const_int 0)), which can get
6866 simplified by validate_replace_rtx during virtual register
6867 instantiation, which can result in unrecognizable insns.
6868 Avoid this by forcing all overflows into registers. */
6869 if (TREE_CONSTANT_OVERFLOW (exp)
6870 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
6871 temp = force_reg (mode, temp);
6873 return temp;
6875 case VECTOR_CST:
6876 return const_vector_from_tree (exp);
6878 case CONST_DECL:
6879 return expand_expr (DECL_INITIAL (exp), target, VOIDmode, modifier);
6881 case REAL_CST:
6882 /* If optimized, generate immediate CONST_DOUBLE
6883 which will be turned into memory by reload if necessary.
6885 We used to force a register so that loop.c could see it. But
6886 this does not allow gen_* patterns to perform optimizations with
6887 the constants. It also produces two insns in cases like "x = 1.0;".
6888 On most machines, floating-point constants are not permitted in
6889 many insns, so we'd end up copying it to a register in any case.
6891 Now, we do the copying in expand_binop, if appropriate. */
6892 return CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (TREE_REAL_CST (exp),
6893 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
6895 case COMPLEX_CST:
6896 /* Handle evaluating a complex constant in a CONCAT target. */
6897 if (original_target && GET_CODE (original_target) == CONCAT)
6899 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
6900 rtx rtarg, itarg;
6902 rtarg = XEXP (original_target, 0);
6903 itarg = XEXP (original_target, 1);
6905 /* Move the real and imaginary parts separately. */
6906 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_REALPART (exp), rtarg, mode, 0);
6907 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_IMAGPART (exp), itarg, mode, 0);
6909 if (op0 != rtarg)
6910 emit_move_insn (rtarg, op0);
6911 if (op1 != itarg)
6912 emit_move_insn (itarg, op1);
6914 return original_target;
6917 /* ... fall through ... */
6919 case STRING_CST:
6920 temp = output_constant_def (exp, 1);
6922 /* temp contains a constant address.
6923 On RISC machines where a constant address isn't valid,
6924 make some insns to get that address into a register. */
6925 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
6926 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
6927 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
6928 && (! memory_address_p (mode, XEXP (temp, 0))
6929 || flag_force_addr))
6930 return replace_equiv_address (temp,
6931 copy_rtx (XEXP (temp, 0)));
6932 return temp;
6934 case EXPR_WITH_FILE_LOCATION:
6936 rtx to_return;
6937 location_t saved_loc = input_location;
6938 input_filename = EXPR_WFL_FILENAME (exp);
6939 input_line = EXPR_WFL_LINENO (exp);
6940 if (EXPR_WFL_EMIT_LINE_NOTE (exp))
6941 emit_line_note (input_location);
6942 /* Possibly avoid switching back and forth here. */
6943 to_return = expand_expr (EXPR_WFL_NODE (exp), target, tmode, modifier);
6944 input_location = saved_loc;
6945 return to_return;
6948 case SAVE_EXPR:
6949 context = decl_function_context (exp);
6951 /* If this SAVE_EXPR was at global context, assume we are an
6952 initialization function and move it into our context. */
6953 if (context == 0)
6954 SAVE_EXPR_CONTEXT (exp) = current_function_decl;
6956 /* We treat inline_function_decl as an alias for the current function
6957 because that is the inline function whose vars, types, etc.
6958 are being merged into the current function.
6959 See expand_inline_function. */
6960 if (context == current_function_decl || context == inline_function_decl)
6961 context = 0;
6963 /* If this is non-local, handle it. */
6964 if (context)
6966 /* The following call just exists to abort if the context is
6967 not of a containing function. */
6968 find_function_data (context);
6970 temp = SAVE_EXPR_RTL (exp);
6971 if (temp && GET_CODE (temp) == REG)
6973 put_var_into_stack (exp, /*rescan=*/true);
6974 temp = SAVE_EXPR_RTL (exp);
6976 if (temp == 0 || GET_CODE (temp) != MEM)
6977 abort ();
6978 return
6979 replace_equiv_address (temp,
6980 fix_lexical_addr (XEXP (temp, 0), exp));
6982 if (SAVE_EXPR_RTL (exp) == 0)
6984 if (mode == VOIDmode)
6985 temp = const0_rtx;
6986 else
6987 temp = assign_temp (build_qualified_type (type,
6988 (TYPE_QUALS (type)
6989 | TYPE_QUAL_CONST)),
6990 3, 0, 0);
6992 SAVE_EXPR_RTL (exp) = temp;
6993 if (!optimize && GET_CODE (temp) == REG)
6994 save_expr_regs = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, temp,
6995 save_expr_regs);
6997 /* If the mode of TEMP does not match that of the expression, it
6998 must be a promoted value. We pass store_expr a SUBREG of the
6999 wanted mode but mark it so that we know that it was already
7000 extended. */
7002 if (GET_CODE (temp) == REG && GET_MODE (temp) != mode)
7004 temp = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (mode, SAVE_EXPR_RTL (exp));
7005 promote_mode (type, mode, &unsignedp, 0);
7006 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (temp) = 1;
7007 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_SET (temp, unsignedp);
7010 if (temp == const0_rtx)
7011 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, 0);
7012 else
7013 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), temp,
7014 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? 2 : 0);
7016 TREE_USED (exp) = 1;
7019 /* If the mode of SAVE_EXPR_RTL does not match that of the expression, it
7020 must be a promoted value. We return a SUBREG of the wanted mode,
7021 but mark it so that we know that it was already extended. */
7023 if (GET_CODE (SAVE_EXPR_RTL (exp)) == REG
7024 && GET_MODE (SAVE_EXPR_RTL (exp)) != mode)
7026 /* Compute the signedness and make the proper SUBREG. */
7027 promote_mode (type, mode, &unsignedp, 0);
7028 temp = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (mode, SAVE_EXPR_RTL (exp));
7029 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (temp) = 1;
7030 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_SET (temp, unsignedp);
7031 return temp;
7034 return SAVE_EXPR_RTL (exp);
7036 case UNSAVE_EXPR:
7038 rtx temp;
7039 temp = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, tmode, modifier);
7040 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)
7041 = (*lang_hooks.unsave_expr_now) (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7042 return temp;
7045 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
7047 tree old_list = placeholder_list;
7048 tree placeholder_expr = 0;
7050 exp = find_placeholder (exp, &placeholder_expr);
7051 if (exp == 0)
7052 abort ();
7054 placeholder_list = TREE_CHAIN (placeholder_expr);
7055 temp = expand_expr (exp, original_target, tmode, modifier);
7056 placeholder_list = old_list;
7057 return temp;
7060 case WITH_RECORD_EXPR:
7061 /* Put the object on the placeholder list, expand our first operand,
7062 and pop the list. */
7063 placeholder_list = tree_cons (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_TREE,
7064 placeholder_list);
7065 target = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), original_target, tmode,
7066 modifier);
7067 placeholder_list = TREE_CHAIN (placeholder_list);
7068 return target;
7070 case GOTO_EXPR:
7071 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == LABEL_DECL)
7072 expand_goto (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7073 else
7074 expand_computed_goto (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7075 return const0_rtx;
7077 case EXIT_EXPR:
7078 expand_exit_loop_if_false (NULL,
7079 invert_truthvalue (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
7080 return const0_rtx;
7082 case LABELED_BLOCK_EXPR:
7083 if (LABELED_BLOCK_BODY (exp))
7084 expand_expr_stmt_value (LABELED_BLOCK_BODY (exp), 0, 1);
7085 /* Should perhaps use expand_label, but this is simpler and safer. */
7086 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
7087 emit_label (label_rtx (LABELED_BLOCK_LABEL (exp)));
7088 return const0_rtx;
7090 case EXIT_BLOCK_EXPR:
7091 if (EXIT_BLOCK_RETURN (exp))
7092 sorry ("returned value in block_exit_expr");
7093 expand_goto (LABELED_BLOCK_LABEL (EXIT_BLOCK_LABELED_BLOCK (exp)));
7094 return const0_rtx;
7096 case LOOP_EXPR:
7097 push_temp_slots ();
7098 expand_start_loop (1);
7099 expand_expr_stmt_value (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0, 1);
7100 expand_end_loop ();
7101 pop_temp_slots ();
7103 return const0_rtx;
7105 case BIND_EXPR:
7107 tree vars = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7109 /* Need to open a binding contour here because
7110 if there are any cleanups they must be contained here. */
7111 expand_start_bindings (2);
7113 /* Mark the corresponding BLOCK for output in its proper place. */
7114 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2) != 0
7115 && ! TREE_USED (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2)))
7116 (*lang_hooks.decls.insert_block) (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2));
7118 /* If VARS have not yet been expanded, expand them now. */
7119 while (vars)
7121 if (!DECL_RTL_SET_P (vars))
7122 expand_decl (vars);
7123 expand_decl_init (vars);
7124 vars = TREE_CHAIN (vars);
7127 temp = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target, tmode, modifier);
7129 expand_end_bindings (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0, 0);
7131 return temp;
7134 case RTL_EXPR:
7135 if (RTL_EXPR_SEQUENCE (exp))
7137 if (RTL_EXPR_SEQUENCE (exp) == const0_rtx)
7138 abort ();
7139 emit_insn (RTL_EXPR_SEQUENCE (exp));
7140 RTL_EXPR_SEQUENCE (exp) = const0_rtx;
7142 preserve_rtl_expr_result (RTL_EXPR_RTL (exp));
7143 free_temps_for_rtl_expr (exp);
7144 return RTL_EXPR_RTL (exp);
7146 case CONSTRUCTOR:
7147 /* If we don't need the result, just ensure we evaluate any
7148 subexpressions. */
7149 if (ignore)
7151 tree elt;
7153 for (elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp); elt; elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt))
7154 expand_expr (TREE_VALUE (elt), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, 0);
7156 return const0_rtx;
7159 /* All elts simple constants => refer to a constant in memory. But
7160 if this is a non-BLKmode mode, let it store a field at a time
7161 since that should make a CONST_INT or CONST_DOUBLE when we
7162 fold. Likewise, if we have a target we can use, it is best to
7163 store directly into the target unless the type is large enough
7164 that memcpy will be used. If we are making an initializer and
7165 all operands are constant, put it in memory as well.
7167 FIXME: Avoid trying to fill vector constructors piece-meal.
7168 Output them with output_constant_def below unless we're sure
7169 they're zeros. This should go away when vector initializers
7170 are treated like VECTOR_CST instead of arrays.
7172 else if ((TREE_STATIC (exp)
7173 && ((mode == BLKmode
7174 && ! (target != 0 && safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)))
7175 || TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
7176 || (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type), 1)
7177 && (! MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
7178 (tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type), 1),
7179 TYPE_ALIGN (type)))
7180 && ((TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE
7181 && !is_zeros_p (exp))
7182 || ! mostly_zeros_p (exp)))))
7183 || ((modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7184 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
7185 && TREE_CONSTANT (exp)))
7187 rtx constructor = output_constant_def (exp, 1);
7189 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
7190 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7191 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM)
7192 constructor = validize_mem (constructor);
7194 return constructor;
7196 else
7198 /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous
7199 locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
7200 if (target == 0 || ! safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)
7201 || GET_CODE (target) == PARALLEL
7202 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7203 target
7204 = assign_temp (build_qualified_type (type,
7205 (TYPE_QUALS (type)
7206 | (TREE_READONLY (exp)
7207 * TYPE_QUAL_CONST))),
7208 0, TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp), 1);
7210 store_constructor (exp, target, 0, int_expr_size (exp));
7211 return target;
7214 case INDIRECT_REF:
7216 tree exp1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7217 tree index;
7218 tree string = string_constant (exp1, &index);
7220 /* Try to optimize reads from const strings. */
7221 if (string
7222 && TREE_CODE (string) == STRING_CST
7223 && TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST
7224 && compare_tree_int (index, TREE_STRING_LENGTH (string)) < 0
7225 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
7226 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
7227 && modifier != EXPAND_WRITE)
7228 return gen_int_mode (TREE_STRING_POINTER (string)
7229 [TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index)], mode);
7231 op0 = expand_expr (exp1, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_SUM);
7232 op0 = memory_address (mode, op0);
7233 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
7234 set_mem_attributes (temp, exp, 0);
7236 /* If we are writing to this object and its type is a record with
7237 readonly fields, we must mark it as readonly so it will
7238 conflict with readonly references to those fields. */
7239 if (modifier == EXPAND_WRITE && readonly_fields_p (type))
7240 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (temp) = 1;
7242 return temp;
7245 case ARRAY_REF:
7246 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) != ARRAY_TYPE)
7247 abort ();
7250 tree array = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7251 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (array));
7252 tree low_bound = domain ? TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain) : integer_zero_node;
7253 tree index = convert (sizetype, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
7254 HOST_WIDE_INT i;
7256 /* Optimize the special-case of a zero lower bound.
7258 We convert the low_bound to sizetype to avoid some problems
7259 with constant folding. (E.g. suppose the lower bound is 1,
7260 and its mode is QI. Without the conversion, (ARRAY
7261 +(INDEX-(unsigned char)1)) becomes ((ARRAY+(-(unsigned char)1))
7262 +INDEX), which becomes (ARRAY+255+INDEX). Oops!) */
7264 if (! integer_zerop (low_bound))
7265 index = size_diffop (index, convert (sizetype, low_bound));
7267 /* Fold an expression like: "foo"[2].
7268 This is not done in fold so it won't happen inside &.
7269 Don't fold if this is for wide characters since it's too
7270 difficult to do correctly and this is a very rare case. */
7272 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
7273 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7274 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
7275 && TREE_CODE (array) == STRING_CST
7276 && TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST
7277 && compare_tree_int (index, TREE_STRING_LENGTH (array)) < 0
7278 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
7279 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1)
7280 return gen_int_mode (TREE_STRING_POINTER (array)
7281 [TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index)], mode);
7283 /* If this is a constant index into a constant array,
7284 just get the value from the array. Handle both the cases when
7285 we have an explicit constructor and when our operand is a variable
7286 that was declared const. */
7288 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
7289 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7290 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
7291 && TREE_CODE (array) == CONSTRUCTOR
7292 && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
7293 && TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST
7294 && 0 > compare_tree_int (index,
7295 list_length (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS
7296 (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))))
7298 tree elem;
7300 for (elem = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)),
7301 i = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index);
7302 elem != 0 && i != 0; i--, elem = TREE_CHAIN (elem))
7305 if (elem)
7306 return expand_expr (fold (TREE_VALUE (elem)), target, tmode,
7307 modifier);
7310 else if (optimize >= 1
7311 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
7312 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7313 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
7314 && TREE_READONLY (array) && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
7315 && TREE_CODE (array) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (array)
7316 && TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (array)) != ERROR_MARK)
7318 if (TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST)
7320 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (array);
7322 if (TREE_CODE (init) == CONSTRUCTOR)
7324 tree elem;
7326 for (elem = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
7327 (elem
7328 && !tree_int_cst_equal (TREE_PURPOSE (elem), index));
7329 elem = TREE_CHAIN (elem))
7332 if (elem && !TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (TREE_VALUE (elem)))
7333 return expand_expr (fold (TREE_VALUE (elem)), target,
7334 tmode, modifier);
7336 else if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST
7337 && 0 > compare_tree_int (index,
7338 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)))
7340 tree type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (init));
7341 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
7343 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
7344 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1)
7345 return gen_int_mode (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)
7346 [TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index)], mode);
7351 goto normal_inner_ref;
7353 case COMPONENT_REF:
7354 /* If the operand is a CONSTRUCTOR, we can just extract the
7355 appropriate field if it is present. */
7356 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == CONSTRUCTOR)
7358 tree elt;
7360 for (elt = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)); elt;
7361 elt = TREE_CHAIN (elt))
7362 if (TREE_PURPOSE (elt) == TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)
7363 /* We can normally use the value of the field in the
7364 CONSTRUCTOR. However, if this is a bitfield in
7365 an integral mode that we can fit in a HOST_WIDE_INT,
7366 we must mask only the number of bits in the bitfield,
7367 since this is done implicitly by the constructor. If
7368 the bitfield does not meet either of those conditions,
7369 we can't do this optimization. */
7370 && (! DECL_BIT_FIELD (TREE_PURPOSE (elt))
7371 || ((GET_MODE_CLASS (DECL_MODE (TREE_PURPOSE (elt)))
7372 == MODE_INT)
7373 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (DECL_MODE (TREE_PURPOSE (elt)))
7374 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT))))
7376 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (TREE_PURPOSE (elt))
7377 && modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7378 target = 0;
7379 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_VALUE (elt), target, tmode, modifier);
7380 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (TREE_PURPOSE (elt)))
7382 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize
7383 = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (DECL_SIZE (TREE_PURPOSE (elt)));
7384 enum machine_mode imode
7385 = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_PURPOSE (elt)));
7387 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_PURPOSE (elt))))
7389 op1 = GEN_INT (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bitsize) - 1);
7390 op0 = expand_and (imode, op0, op1, target);
7392 else
7394 tree count
7395 = build_int_2 (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (imode) - bitsize,
7398 op0 = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, imode, op0, count,
7399 target, 0);
7400 op0 = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, imode, op0, count,
7401 target, 0);
7405 return op0;
7408 goto normal_inner_ref;
7410 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
7411 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
7412 normal_inner_ref:
7414 enum machine_mode mode1;
7415 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
7416 tree offset;
7417 int volatilep = 0;
7418 tree tem = get_inner_reference (exp, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
7419 &mode1, &unsignedp, &volatilep);
7420 rtx orig_op0;
7422 /* If we got back the original object, something is wrong. Perhaps
7423 we are evaluating an expression too early. In any event, don't
7424 infinitely recurse. */
7425 if (tem == exp)
7426 abort ();
7428 /* If TEM's type is a union of variable size, pass TARGET to the inner
7429 computation, since it will need a temporary and TARGET is known
7430 to have to do. This occurs in unchecked conversion in Ada. */
7432 orig_op0 = op0
7433 = expand_expr (tem,
7434 (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) == UNION_TYPE
7435 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (tem)))
7436 != INTEGER_CST)
7437 && modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
7438 ? target : NULL_RTX),
7439 VOIDmode,
7440 (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7441 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
7442 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7443 ? modifier : EXPAND_NORMAL);
7445 /* If this is a constant, put it into a register if it is a
7446 legitimate constant and OFFSET is 0 and memory if it isn't. */
7447 if (CONSTANT_P (op0))
7449 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (tem));
7450 if (mode != BLKmode && LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (op0)
7451 && offset == 0)
7452 op0 = force_reg (mode, op0);
7453 else
7454 op0 = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, op0));
7457 /* Otherwise, if this object not in memory and we either have an
7458 offset or a BLKmode result, put it there. This case can't occur in
7459 C, but can in Ada if we have unchecked conversion of an expression
7460 from a scalar type to an array or record type or for an
7461 ARRAY_RANGE_REF whose type is BLKmode. */
7462 else if (GET_CODE (op0) != MEM
7463 && (offset != 0
7464 || (code == ARRAY_RANGE_REF && mode == BLKmode)))
7466 /* If the operand is a SAVE_EXPR, we can deal with this by
7467 forcing the SAVE_EXPR into memory. */
7468 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == SAVE_EXPR)
7470 put_var_into_stack (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),
7471 /*rescan=*/true);
7472 op0 = SAVE_EXPR_RTL (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7474 else
7476 tree nt
7477 = build_qualified_type (TREE_TYPE (tem),
7478 (TYPE_QUALS (TREE_TYPE (tem))
7479 | TYPE_QUAL_CONST));
7480 rtx memloc = assign_temp (nt, 1, 1, 1);
7482 emit_move_insn (memloc, op0);
7483 op0 = memloc;
7487 if (offset != 0)
7489 rtx offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
7490 EXPAND_SUM);
7492 if (GET_CODE (op0) != MEM)
7493 abort ();
7495 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
7496 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != Pmode)
7497 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (Pmode, offset_rtx, 0);
7498 #else
7499 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != ptr_mode)
7500 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (ptr_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
7501 #endif
7503 /* A constant address in OP0 can have VOIDmode, we must not try
7504 to call force_reg for that case. Avoid that case. */
7505 if (GET_CODE (op0) == MEM
7506 && GET_MODE (op0) == BLKmode
7507 && GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) != VOIDmode
7508 && bitsize != 0
7509 && (bitpos % bitsize) == 0
7510 && (bitsize % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)) == 0
7511 && MEM_ALIGN (op0) == GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
7513 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
7514 bitpos = 0;
7517 op0 = offset_address (op0, offset_rtx,
7518 highest_pow2_factor (offset));
7521 /* If OFFSET is making OP0 more aligned than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT,
7522 record its alignment as BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
7523 if (GET_CODE (op0) == MEM && bitpos == 0 && offset != 0
7524 && is_aligning_offset (offset, tem))
7525 set_mem_align (op0, BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT);
7527 /* Don't forget about volatility even if this is a bitfield. */
7528 if (GET_CODE (op0) == MEM && volatilep && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0))
7530 if (op0 == orig_op0)
7531 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
7533 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) = 1;
7536 /* The following code doesn't handle CONCAT.
7537 Assume only bitpos == 0 can be used for CONCAT, due to
7538 one element arrays having the same mode as its element. */
7539 if (GET_CODE (op0) == CONCAT)
7541 if (bitpos != 0 || bitsize != GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)))
7542 abort ();
7543 return op0;
7546 /* In cases where an aligned union has an unaligned object
7547 as a field, we might be extracting a BLKmode value from
7548 an integer-mode (e.g., SImode) object. Handle this case
7549 by doing the extract into an object as wide as the field
7550 (which we know to be the width of a basic mode), then
7551 storing into memory, and changing the mode to BLKmode. */
7552 if (mode1 == VOIDmode
7553 || GET_CODE (op0) == REG || GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG
7554 || (mode1 != BLKmode && ! direct_load[(int) mode1]
7555 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
7556 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
7557 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
7558 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7559 /* If the field isn't aligned enough to fetch as a memref,
7560 fetch it as a bit field. */
7561 || (mode1 != BLKmode
7562 && (((TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (tem)) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
7563 || (bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) != 0))
7564 && ((modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
7565 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7566 ? STRICT_ALIGNMENT
7567 : SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode1, MEM_ALIGN (op0))))
7568 || (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)))
7569 /* If the type and the field are a constant size and the
7570 size of the type isn't the same size as the bitfield,
7571 we must use bitfield operations. */
7572 || (bitsize >= 0
7573 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
7574 == INTEGER_CST)
7575 && 0 != compare_tree_int (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
7576 bitsize)))
7578 enum machine_mode ext_mode = mode;
7580 if (ext_mode == BLKmode
7581 && ! (target != 0 && GET_CODE (op0) == MEM
7582 && GET_CODE (target) == MEM
7583 && bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0))
7584 ext_mode = mode_for_size (bitsize, MODE_INT, 1);
7586 if (ext_mode == BLKmode)
7588 /* In this case, BITPOS must start at a byte boundary and
7589 TARGET, if specified, must be a MEM. */
7590 if (GET_CODE (op0) != MEM
7591 || (target != 0 && GET_CODE (target) != MEM)
7592 || bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
7593 abort ();
7595 op0 = adjust_address (op0, VOIDmode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
7596 if (target == 0)
7597 target = assign_temp (type, 0, 1, 1);
7599 emit_block_move (target, op0,
7600 GEN_INT ((bitsize + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1)
7601 / BITS_PER_UNIT),
7602 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
7603 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
7605 return target;
7608 op0 = validize_mem (op0);
7610 if (GET_CODE (op0) == MEM && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) == REG)
7611 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
7613 op0 = extract_bit_field (op0, bitsize, bitpos, unsignedp,
7614 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
7615 ? NULL_RTX : target),
7616 ext_mode, ext_mode,
7617 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (tem)));
7619 /* If the result is a record type and BITSIZE is narrower than
7620 the mode of OP0, an integral mode, and this is a big endian
7621 machine, we must put the field into the high-order bits. */
7622 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
7623 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op0)) == MODE_INT
7624 && bitsize < (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)))
7625 op0 = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (op0), op0,
7626 size_int (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0))
7627 - bitsize),
7628 op0, 1);
7630 if (mode == BLKmode)
7632 rtx new = assign_temp (build_qualified_type
7633 ((*lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode)
7634 (ext_mode, 0),
7635 TYPE_QUAL_CONST), 0, 1, 1);
7637 emit_move_insn (new, op0);
7638 op0 = copy_rtx (new);
7639 PUT_MODE (op0, BLKmode);
7640 set_mem_attributes (op0, exp, 1);
7643 return op0;
7646 /* If the result is BLKmode, use that to access the object
7647 now as well. */
7648 if (mode == BLKmode)
7649 mode1 = BLKmode;
7651 /* Get a reference to just this component. */
7652 if (modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
7653 || modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7654 op0 = adjust_address_nv (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
7655 else
7656 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
7658 if (op0 == orig_op0)
7659 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
7661 set_mem_attributes (op0, exp, 0);
7662 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) == REG)
7663 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
7665 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) |= volatilep;
7666 if (mode == mode1 || mode1 == BLKmode || mode1 == tmode
7667 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
7668 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7669 return op0;
7670 else if (target == 0)
7671 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
7673 convert_move (target, op0, unsignedp);
7674 return target;
7677 case VTABLE_REF:
7679 rtx insn, before = get_last_insn (), vtbl_ref;
7681 /* Evaluate the interior expression. */
7682 subtarget = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target,
7683 tmode, modifier);
7685 /* Get or create an instruction off which to hang a note. */
7686 if (REG_P (subtarget))
7688 target = subtarget;
7689 insn = get_last_insn ();
7690 if (insn == before)
7691 abort ();
7692 if (! INSN_P (insn))
7693 insn = prev_nonnote_insn (insn);
7695 else
7697 target = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (subtarget));
7698 insn = emit_move_insn (target, subtarget);
7701 /* Collect the data for the note. */
7702 vtbl_ref = XEXP (DECL_RTL (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)), 0);
7703 vtbl_ref = plus_constant (vtbl_ref,
7704 tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), 0));
7705 /* Discard the initial CONST that was added. */
7706 vtbl_ref = XEXP (vtbl_ref, 0);
7708 REG_NOTES (insn)
7709 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_VTABLE_REF, vtbl_ref, REG_NOTES (insn));
7711 return target;
7714 /* Intended for a reference to a buffer of a file-object in Pascal.
7715 But it's not certain that a special tree code will really be
7716 necessary for these. INDIRECT_REF might work for them. */
7717 case BUFFER_REF:
7718 abort ();
7720 case IN_EXPR:
7722 /* Pascal set IN expression.
7724 Algorithm:
7725 rlo = set_low - (set_low%bits_per_word);
7726 the_word = set [ (index - rlo)/bits_per_word ];
7727 bit_index = index % bits_per_word;
7728 bitmask = 1 << bit_index;
7729 return !!(the_word & bitmask); */
7731 tree set = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7732 tree index = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
7733 int iunsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (index));
7734 tree set_type = TREE_TYPE (set);
7735 tree set_low_bound = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (set_type));
7736 tree set_high_bound = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (set_type));
7737 rtx index_val = expand_expr (index, 0, VOIDmode, 0);
7738 rtx lo_r = expand_expr (set_low_bound, 0, VOIDmode, 0);
7739 rtx hi_r = expand_expr (set_high_bound, 0, VOIDmode, 0);
7740 rtx setval = expand_expr (set, 0, VOIDmode, 0);
7741 rtx setaddr = XEXP (setval, 0);
7742 enum machine_mode index_mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (index));
7743 rtx rlow;
7744 rtx diff, quo, rem, addr, bit, result;
7746 /* If domain is empty, answer is no. Likewise if index is constant
7747 and out of bounds. */
7748 if (((TREE_CODE (set_high_bound) == INTEGER_CST
7749 && TREE_CODE (set_low_bound) == INTEGER_CST
7750 && tree_int_cst_lt (set_high_bound, set_low_bound))
7751 || (TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST
7752 && TREE_CODE (set_low_bound) == INTEGER_CST
7753 && tree_int_cst_lt (index, set_low_bound))
7754 || (TREE_CODE (set_high_bound) == INTEGER_CST
7755 && TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST
7756 && tree_int_cst_lt (set_high_bound, index))))
7757 return const0_rtx;
7759 if (target == 0)
7760 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
7762 /* If we get here, we have to generate the code for both cases
7763 (in range and out of range). */
7765 op0 = gen_label_rtx ();
7766 op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
7768 if (! (GET_CODE (index_val) == CONST_INT
7769 && GET_CODE (lo_r) == CONST_INT))
7770 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (index_val, lo_r, LT, NULL_RTX,
7771 GET_MODE (index_val), iunsignedp, op1);
7773 if (! (GET_CODE (index_val) == CONST_INT
7774 && GET_CODE (hi_r) == CONST_INT))
7775 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (index_val, hi_r, GT, NULL_RTX,
7776 GET_MODE (index_val), iunsignedp, op1);
7778 /* Calculate the element number of bit zero in the first word
7779 of the set. */
7780 if (GET_CODE (lo_r) == CONST_INT)
7781 rlow = GEN_INT (INTVAL (lo_r)
7782 & ~((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << BITS_PER_UNIT));
7783 else
7784 rlow = expand_binop (index_mode, and_optab, lo_r,
7785 GEN_INT (~((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << BITS_PER_UNIT)),
7786 NULL_RTX, iunsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7788 diff = expand_binop (index_mode, sub_optab, index_val, rlow,
7789 NULL_RTX, iunsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7791 quo = expand_divmod (0, TRUNC_DIV_EXPR, index_mode, diff,
7792 GEN_INT (BITS_PER_UNIT), NULL_RTX, iunsignedp);
7793 rem = expand_divmod (1, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, index_mode, index_val,
7794 GEN_INT (BITS_PER_UNIT), NULL_RTX, iunsignedp);
7796 addr = memory_address (byte_mode,
7797 expand_binop (index_mode, add_optab, diff,
7798 setaddr, NULL_RTX, iunsignedp,
7799 OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN));
7801 /* Extract the bit we want to examine. */
7802 bit = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, byte_mode,
7803 gen_rtx_MEM (byte_mode, addr),
7804 make_tree (TREE_TYPE (index), rem),
7805 NULL_RTX, 1);
7806 result = expand_binop (byte_mode, and_optab, bit, const1_rtx,
7807 GET_MODE (target) == byte_mode ? target : 0,
7808 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7810 if (result != target)
7811 convert_move (target, result, 1);
7813 /* Output the code to handle the out-of-range case. */
7814 emit_jump (op0);
7815 emit_label (op1);
7816 emit_move_insn (target, const0_rtx);
7817 emit_label (op0);
7818 return target;
7821 case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
7822 if (WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR_RTL (exp) == 0)
7824 WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR_RTL (exp)
7825 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, tmode, modifier);
7826 expand_decl_cleanup_eh (NULL_TREE, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
7827 CLEANUP_EH_ONLY (exp));
7829 /* That's it for this cleanup. */
7830 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1) = 0;
7832 return WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR_RTL (exp);
7834 case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
7836 /* Start a new binding layer that will keep track of all cleanup
7837 actions to be performed. */
7838 expand_start_bindings (2);
7840 target_temp_slot_level = temp_slot_level;
7842 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, tmode, modifier);
7843 /* If we're going to use this value, load it up now. */
7844 if (! ignore)
7845 op0 = force_not_mem (op0);
7846 preserve_temp_slots (op0);
7847 expand_end_bindings (NULL_TREE, 0, 0);
7849 return op0;
7851 case CALL_EXPR:
7852 /* Check for a built-in function. */
7853 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
7854 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
7855 == FUNCTION_DECL)
7856 && DECL_BUILT_IN (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)))
7858 if (DECL_BUILT_IN_CLASS (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
7859 == BUILT_IN_FRONTEND)
7860 return (*lang_hooks.expand_expr) (exp, original_target,
7861 tmode, modifier);
7862 else
7863 return expand_builtin (exp, target, subtarget, tmode, ignore);
7866 return expand_call (exp, target, ignore);
7868 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
7869 case NOP_EXPR:
7870 case CONVERT_EXPR:
7871 case REFERENCE_EXPR:
7872 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) == error_mark_node)
7873 return const0_rtx;
7875 if (TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
7877 tree valtype = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7879 /* If both input and output are BLKmode, this conversion isn't doing
7880 anything except possibly changing memory attribute. */
7881 if (mode == BLKmode && TYPE_MODE (valtype) == BLKmode)
7883 rtx result = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, tmode,
7884 modifier);
7886 result = copy_rtx (result);
7887 set_mem_attributes (result, exp, 0);
7888 return result;
7891 if (target == 0)
7892 target = assign_temp (type, 0, 1, 1);
7894 if (GET_CODE (target) == MEM)
7895 /* Store data into beginning of memory target. */
7896 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),
7897 adjust_address (target, TYPE_MODE (valtype), 0),
7898 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? 2 : 0);
7900 else if (GET_CODE (target) == REG)
7901 /* Store this field into a union of the proper type. */
7902 store_field (target,
7903 MIN ((int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE
7904 (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
7905 * BITS_PER_UNIT),
7906 (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)),
7907 0, TYPE_MODE (valtype), TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),
7908 VOIDmode, 0, type, 0);
7909 else
7910 abort ();
7912 /* Return the entire union. */
7913 return target;
7916 if (mode == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))
7918 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, VOIDmode,
7919 modifier);
7921 /* If the signedness of the conversion differs and OP0 is
7922 a promoted SUBREG, clear that indication since we now
7923 have to do the proper extension. */
7924 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) != unsignedp
7925 && GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG)
7926 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (op0) = 0;
7928 return op0;
7931 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), NULL_RTX, mode, modifier);
7932 if (GET_MODE (op0) == mode)
7933 return op0;
7935 /* If OP0 is a constant, just convert it into the proper mode. */
7936 if (CONSTANT_P (op0))
7938 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7939 enum machine_mode inner_mode = TYPE_MODE (inner_type);
7941 if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7942 return simplify_gen_subreg (mode, op0, inner_mode,
7943 subreg_lowpart_offset (mode,
7944 inner_mode));
7945 else
7946 return convert_modes (mode, inner_mode, op0,
7947 TREE_UNSIGNED (inner_type));
7950 if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7951 return gen_rtx_fmt_e (unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND, mode, op0);
7953 if (target == 0)
7954 return
7955 convert_to_mode (mode, op0,
7956 TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
7957 else
7958 convert_move (target, op0,
7959 TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
7960 return target;
7962 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
7963 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), NULL_RTX, mode, modifier);
7965 /* If the input and output modes are both the same, we are done.
7966 Otherwise, if neither mode is BLKmode and both are integral and within
7967 a word, we can use gen_lowpart. If neither is true, make sure the
7968 operand is in memory and convert the MEM to the new mode. */
7969 if (TYPE_MODE (type) == GET_MODE (op0))
7971 else if (TYPE_MODE (type) != BLKmode && GET_MODE (op0) != BLKmode
7972 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op0)) == MODE_INT
7973 && GET_MODE_CLASS (TYPE_MODE (type)) == MODE_INT
7974 && GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (type)) <= UNITS_PER_WORD
7975 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (op0)) <= UNITS_PER_WORD)
7976 op0 = gen_lowpart (TYPE_MODE (type), op0);
7977 else if (GET_CODE (op0) != MEM)
7979 /* If the operand is not a MEM, force it into memory. Since we
7980 are going to be be changing the mode of the MEM, don't call
7981 force_const_mem for constants because we don't allow pool
7982 constants to change mode. */
7983 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7985 if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp))
7986 abort ();
7988 if (target == 0 || GET_MODE (target) != TYPE_MODE (inner_type))
7989 target
7990 = assign_stack_temp_for_type
7991 (TYPE_MODE (inner_type),
7992 GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (inner_type)), 0, inner_type);
7994 emit_move_insn (target, op0);
7995 op0 = target;
7998 /* At this point, OP0 is in the correct mode. If the output type is such
7999 that the operand is known to be aligned, indicate that it is.
8000 Otherwise, we need only be concerned about alignment for non-BLKmode
8001 results. */
8002 if (GET_CODE (op0) == MEM)
8004 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
8006 if (TYPE_ALIGN_OK (type))
8007 set_mem_align (op0, MAX (MEM_ALIGN (op0), TYPE_ALIGN (type)));
8008 else if (TYPE_MODE (type) != BLKmode && STRICT_ALIGNMENT
8009 && MEM_ALIGN (op0) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (TYPE_MODE (type)))
8011 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
8012 HOST_WIDE_INT temp_size
8013 = MAX (int_size_in_bytes (inner_type),
8014 (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (type)));
8015 rtx new = assign_stack_temp_for_type (TYPE_MODE (type),
8016 temp_size, 0, type);
8017 rtx new_with_op0_mode = adjust_address (new, GET_MODE (op0), 0);
8019 if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp))
8020 abort ();
8022 if (GET_MODE (op0) == BLKmode)
8023 emit_block_move (new_with_op0_mode, op0,
8024 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (type))),
8025 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
8026 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
8027 else
8028 emit_move_insn (new_with_op0_mode, op0);
8030 op0 = new;
8033 op0 = adjust_address (op0, TYPE_MODE (type), 0);
8036 return op0;
8038 case PLUS_EXPR:
8039 this_optab = ! unsignedp && flag_trapv
8040 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT)
8041 ? addv_optab : add_optab;
8043 /* If we are adding a constant, an RTL_EXPR that is sp, fp, or ap, and
8044 something else, make sure we add the register to the constant and
8045 then to the other thing. This case can occur during strength
8046 reduction and doing it this way will produce better code if the
8047 frame pointer or argument pointer is eliminated.
8049 fold-const.c will ensure that the constant is always in the inner
8050 PLUS_EXPR, so the only case we need to do anything about is if
8051 sp, ap, or fp is our second argument, in which case we must swap
8052 the innermost first argument and our second argument. */
8054 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == PLUS_EXPR
8055 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 1)) == INTEGER_CST
8056 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == RTL_EXPR
8057 && (RTL_EXPR_RTL (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == frame_pointer_rtx
8058 || RTL_EXPR_RTL (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == stack_pointer_rtx
8059 || RTL_EXPR_RTL (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == arg_pointer_rtx))
8061 tree t = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
8063 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1) = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
8064 TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0) = t;
8067 /* If the result is to be ptr_mode and we are adding an integer to
8068 something, we might be forming a constant. So try to use
8069 plus_constant. If it produces a sum and we can't accept it,
8070 use force_operand. This allows P = &ARR[const] to generate
8071 efficient code on machines where a SYMBOL_REF is not a valid
8072 address.
8074 If this is an EXPAND_SUM call, always return the sum. */
8075 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8076 || (mode == ptr_mode && (unsignedp || ! flag_trapv)))
8078 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8079 target = 0;
8080 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == INTEGER_CST
8081 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
8082 && TREE_CONSTANT (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
8084 rtx constant_part;
8086 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), subtarget, VOIDmode,
8087 EXPAND_SUM);
8088 /* Use immed_double_const to ensure that the constant is
8089 truncated according to the mode of OP1, then sign extended
8090 to a HOST_WIDE_INT. Using the constant directly can result
8091 in non-canonical RTL in a 64x32 cross compile. */
8092 constant_part
8093 = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)),
8094 (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0,
8095 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))));
8096 op1 = plus_constant (op1, INTVAL (constant_part));
8097 if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8098 op1 = force_operand (op1, target);
8099 return op1;
8102 else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
8103 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_INT
8104 && TREE_CONSTANT (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
8106 rtx constant_part;
8108 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode,
8109 (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8110 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_SUM));
8111 if (! CONSTANT_P (op0))
8113 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX,
8114 VOIDmode, modifier);
8115 /* Don't go to both_summands if modifier
8116 says it's not right to return a PLUS. */
8117 if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8118 goto binop2;
8119 goto both_summands;
8121 /* Use immed_double_const to ensure that the constant is
8122 truncated according to the mode of OP1, then sign extended
8123 to a HOST_WIDE_INT. Using the constant directly can result
8124 in non-canonical RTL in a 64x32 cross compile. */
8125 constant_part
8126 = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)),
8127 (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0,
8128 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
8129 op0 = plus_constant (op0, INTVAL (constant_part));
8130 if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8131 op0 = force_operand (op0, target);
8132 return op0;
8136 if (! safe_from_p (subtarget, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
8137 subtarget = 0;
8139 /* No sense saving up arithmetic to be done
8140 if it's all in the wrong mode to form part of an address.
8141 And force_operand won't know whether to sign-extend or
8142 zero-extend. */
8143 if ((modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8144 || mode != ptr_mode)
8146 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
8147 if (! operand_equal_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),
8148 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0))
8149 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8150 else
8151 op1 = op0;
8152 if (op0 == const0_rtx)
8153 return op1;
8154 if (op1 == const0_rtx)
8155 return op0;
8156 goto binop2;
8159 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, modifier);
8160 if (! operand_equal_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),
8161 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0))
8162 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX,
8163 VOIDmode, modifier);
8164 else
8165 op1 = op0;
8167 /* We come here from MINUS_EXPR when the second operand is a
8168 constant. */
8169 both_summands:
8170 /* Make sure any term that's a sum with a constant comes last. */
8171 if (GET_CODE (op0) == PLUS
8172 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (op0, 1)))
8174 temp = op0;
8175 op0 = op1;
8176 op1 = temp;
8178 /* If adding to a sum including a constant,
8179 associate it to put the constant outside. */
8180 if (GET_CODE (op1) == PLUS
8181 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (op1, 1)))
8183 rtx constant_term = const0_rtx;
8185 temp = simplify_binary_operation (PLUS, mode, XEXP (op1, 0), op0);
8186 if (temp != 0)
8187 op0 = temp;
8188 /* Ensure that MULT comes first if there is one. */
8189 else if (GET_CODE (op0) == MULT)
8190 op0 = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, op0, XEXP (op1, 0));
8191 else
8192 op0 = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, XEXP (op1, 0), op0);
8194 /* Let's also eliminate constants from op0 if possible. */
8195 op0 = eliminate_constant_term (op0, &constant_term);
8197 /* CONSTANT_TERM and XEXP (op1, 1) are known to be constant, so
8198 their sum should be a constant. Form it into OP1, since the
8199 result we want will then be OP0 + OP1. */
8201 temp = simplify_binary_operation (PLUS, mode, constant_term,
8202 XEXP (op1, 1));
8203 if (temp != 0)
8204 op1 = temp;
8205 else
8206 op1 = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, constant_term, XEXP (op1, 1));
8209 /* Put a constant term last and put a multiplication first. */
8210 if (CONSTANT_P (op0) || GET_CODE (op1) == MULT)
8211 temp = op1, op1 = op0, op0 = temp;
8213 temp = simplify_binary_operation (PLUS, mode, op0, op1);
8214 return temp ? temp : gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, op0, op1);
8216 case MINUS_EXPR:
8217 /* For initializers, we are allowed to return a MINUS of two
8218 symbolic constants. Here we handle all cases when both operands
8219 are constant. */
8220 /* Handle difference of two symbolic constants,
8221 for the sake of an initializer. */
8222 if ((modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8223 && really_constant_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
8224 && really_constant_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
8226 rtx op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
8227 modifier);
8228 rtx op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
8229 modifier);
8231 /* If the last operand is a CONST_INT, use plus_constant of
8232 the negated constant. Else make the MINUS. */
8233 if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT)
8234 return plus_constant (op0, - INTVAL (op1));
8235 else
8236 return gen_rtx_MINUS (mode, op0, op1);
8239 this_optab = ! unsignedp && flag_trapv
8240 && (GET_MODE_CLASS(mode) == MODE_INT)
8241 ? subv_optab : sub_optab;
8243 /* No sense saving up arithmetic to be done
8244 if it's all in the wrong mode to form part of an address.
8245 And force_operand won't know whether to sign-extend or
8246 zero-extend. */
8247 if ((modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8248 || mode != ptr_mode)
8249 goto binop;
8251 if (! safe_from_p (subtarget, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
8252 subtarget = 0;
8254 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, modifier);
8255 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
8257 /* Convert A - const to A + (-const). */
8258 if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT)
8260 op1 = negate_rtx (mode, op1);
8261 goto both_summands;
8264 goto binop2;
8266 case MULT_EXPR:
8267 /* If first operand is constant, swap them.
8268 Thus the following special case checks need only
8269 check the second operand. */
8270 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == INTEGER_CST)
8272 tree t1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
8273 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
8274 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1) = t1;
8277 /* Attempt to return something suitable for generating an
8278 indexed address, for machines that support that. */
8280 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM && mode == ptr_mode
8281 && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0))
8283 tree exp1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
8285 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode,
8286 EXPAND_SUM);
8288 /* If we knew for certain that this is arithmetic for an array
8289 reference, and we knew the bounds of the array, then we could
8290 apply the distributive law across (PLUS X C) for constant C.
8291 Without such knowledge, we risk overflowing the computation
8292 when both X and C are large, but X+C isn't. */
8293 /* ??? Could perhaps special-case EXP being unsigned and C being
8294 positive. In that case we are certain that X+C is no smaller
8295 than X and so the transformed expression will overflow iff the
8296 original would have. */
8298 if (GET_CODE (op0) != REG)
8299 op0 = force_operand (op0, NULL_RTX);
8300 if (GET_CODE (op0) != REG)
8301 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, op0);
8303 return gen_rtx_MULT (mode, op0,
8304 gen_int_mode (tree_low_cst (exp1, 0),
8305 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp1))));
8308 if (! safe_from_p (subtarget, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
8309 subtarget = 0;
8311 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8312 target = 0;
8314 /* Check for multiplying things that have been extended
8315 from a narrower type. If this machine supports multiplying
8316 in that narrower type with a result in the desired type,
8317 do it that way, and avoid the explicit type-conversion. */
8318 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == NOP_EXPR
8319 && TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE
8320 && (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)))
8321 < TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))
8322 && ((TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
8323 && int_fits_type_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
8324 TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)))
8325 /* Don't use a widening multiply if a shift will do. */
8326 && ((GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))))
8327 > HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
8328 || exact_log2 (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))) < 0))
8330 (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == NOP_EXPR
8331 && (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0)))
8333 TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))))
8334 /* If both operands are extended, they must either both
8335 be zero-extended or both be sign-extended. */
8336 && (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0)))
8338 TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)))))))
8340 enum machine_mode innermode
8341 = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)));
8342 optab other_optab = (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)))
8343 ? smul_widen_optab : umul_widen_optab);
8344 this_optab = (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)))
8345 ? umul_widen_optab : smul_widen_optab);
8346 if (mode == GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (innermode))
8348 if (this_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8350 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0),
8351 NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8352 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == INTEGER_CST)
8353 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX,
8354 VOIDmode, 0);
8355 else
8356 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0),
8357 NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8358 goto binop2;
8360 else if (other_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code != CODE_FOR_nothing
8361 && innermode == word_mode)
8363 rtx htem;
8364 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0),
8365 NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8366 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == INTEGER_CST)
8367 op1 = convert_modes (innermode, mode,
8368 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
8369 NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0),
8370 unsignedp);
8371 else
8372 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0),
8373 NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8374 temp = expand_binop (mode, other_optab, op0, op1, target,
8375 unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8376 htem = expand_mult_highpart_adjust (innermode,
8377 gen_highpart (innermode, temp),
8378 op0, op1,
8379 gen_highpart (innermode, temp),
8380 unsignedp);
8381 emit_move_insn (gen_highpart (innermode, temp), htem);
8382 return temp;
8386 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
8387 if (! operand_equal_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),
8388 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0))
8389 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8390 else
8391 op1 = op0;
8392 return expand_mult (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
8394 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
8395 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
8396 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
8397 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
8398 case EXACT_DIV_EXPR:
8399 if (! safe_from_p (subtarget, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
8400 subtarget = 0;
8401 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8402 target = 0;
8403 /* Possible optimization: compute the dividend with EXPAND_SUM
8404 then if the divisor is constant can optimize the case
8405 where some terms of the dividend have coeffs divisible by it. */
8406 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
8407 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8408 return expand_divmod (0, code, mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
8410 case RDIV_EXPR:
8411 /* Emit a/b as a*(1/b). Later we may manage CSE the reciprocal saving
8412 expensive divide. If not, combine will rebuild the original
8413 computation. */
8414 if (flag_unsafe_math_optimizations && optimize && !optimize_size
8415 && TREE_CODE (type) == REAL_TYPE
8416 && !real_onep (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
8417 return expand_expr (build (MULT_EXPR, type, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),
8418 build (RDIV_EXPR, type,
8419 build_real (type, dconst1),
8420 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))),
8421 target, tmode, modifier);
8422 this_optab = sdiv_optab;
8423 goto binop;
8425 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
8426 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
8427 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
8428 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
8429 if (! safe_from_p (subtarget, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
8430 subtarget = 0;
8431 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8432 target = 0;
8433 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
8434 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8435 return expand_divmod (1, code, mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
8437 case FIX_ROUND_EXPR:
8438 case FIX_FLOOR_EXPR:
8439 case FIX_CEIL_EXPR:
8440 abort (); /* Not used for C. */
8442 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
8443 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8444 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8445 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8446 expand_fix (target, op0, unsignedp);
8447 return target;
8449 case FLOAT_EXPR:
8450 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8451 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8452 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8453 /* expand_float can't figure out what to do if FROM has VOIDmode.
8454 So give it the correct mode. With -O, cse will optimize this. */
8455 if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode)
8456 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))),
8457 op0);
8458 expand_float (target, op0,
8459 TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
8460 return target;
8462 case NEGATE_EXPR:
8463 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
8464 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8465 target = 0;
8466 temp = expand_unop (mode,
8467 ! unsignedp && flag_trapv
8468 && (GET_MODE_CLASS(mode) == MODE_INT)
8469 ? negv_optab : neg_optab, op0, target, 0);
8470 if (temp == 0)
8471 abort ();
8472 return temp;
8474 case ABS_EXPR:
8475 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
8476 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8477 target = 0;
8479 /* Handle complex values specially. */
8480 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_COMPLEX_INT
8481 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT)
8482 return expand_complex_abs (mode, op0, target, unsignedp);
8484 /* Unsigned abs is simply the operand. Testing here means we don't
8485 risk generating incorrect code below. */
8486 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (type))
8487 return op0;
8489 return expand_abs (mode, op0, target, unsignedp,
8490 safe_from_p (target, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 1));
8492 case MAX_EXPR:
8493 case MIN_EXPR:
8494 target = original_target;
8495 if (target == 0
8496 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
8497 || ! safe_from_p (target, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1)
8498 || (GET_CODE (target) == MEM && MEM_VOLATILE_P (target))
8499 || GET_MODE (target) != mode
8500 || (GET_CODE (target) == REG
8501 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
8502 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8503 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8504 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, VOIDmode, 0);
8506 /* First try to do it with a special MIN or MAX instruction.
8507 If that does not win, use a conditional jump to select the proper
8508 value. */
8509 this_optab = (TREE_UNSIGNED (type)
8510 ? (code == MIN_EXPR ? umin_optab : umax_optab)
8511 : (code == MIN_EXPR ? smin_optab : smax_optab));
8513 temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target, unsignedp,
8514 OPTAB_WIDEN);
8515 if (temp != 0)
8516 return temp;
8518 /* At this point, a MEM target is no longer useful; we will get better
8519 code without it. */
8521 if (GET_CODE (target) == MEM)
8522 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8524 if (target != op0)
8525 emit_move_insn (target, op0);
8527 op0 = gen_label_rtx ();
8529 /* If this mode is an integer too wide to compare properly,
8530 compare word by word. Rely on cse to optimize constant cases. */
8531 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
8532 && ! can_compare_p (GE, mode, ccp_jump))
8534 if (code == MAX_EXPR)
8535 do_jump_by_parts_greater_rtx (mode, TREE_UNSIGNED (type),
8536 target, op1, NULL_RTX, op0);
8537 else
8538 do_jump_by_parts_greater_rtx (mode, TREE_UNSIGNED (type),
8539 op1, target, NULL_RTX, op0);
8541 else
8543 int unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)));
8544 do_compare_rtx_and_jump (target, op1, code == MAX_EXPR ? GE : LE,
8545 unsignedp, mode, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX,
8546 op0);
8548 emit_move_insn (target, op1);
8549 emit_label (op0);
8550 return target;
8552 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
8553 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
8554 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8555 target = 0;
8556 temp = expand_unop (mode, one_cmpl_optab, op0, target, 1);
8557 if (temp == 0)
8558 abort ();
8559 return temp;
8561 case FFS_EXPR:
8562 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
8563 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8564 target = 0;
8565 temp = expand_unop (mode, ffs_optab, op0, target, 1);
8566 if (temp == 0)
8567 abort ();
8568 return temp;
8570 case CLZ_EXPR:
8571 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
8572 temp = expand_unop (mode, clz_optab, op0, target, 1);
8573 if (temp == 0)
8574 abort ();
8575 return temp;
8577 case CTZ_EXPR:
8578 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
8579 temp = expand_unop (mode, ctz_optab, op0, target, 1);
8580 if (temp == 0)
8581 abort ();
8582 return temp;
8584 case POPCOUNT_EXPR:
8585 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
8586 temp = expand_unop (mode, popcount_optab, op0, target, 1);
8587 if (temp == 0)
8588 abort ();
8589 return temp;
8591 case PARITY_EXPR:
8592 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
8593 temp = expand_unop (mode, parity_optab, op0, target, 1);
8594 if (temp == 0)
8595 abort ();
8596 return temp;
8598 /* ??? Can optimize bitwise operations with one arg constant.
8599 Can optimize (a bitwise1 n) bitwise2 (a bitwise3 b)
8600 and (a bitwise1 b) bitwise2 b (etc)
8601 but that is probably not worth while. */
8603 /* BIT_AND_EXPR is for bitwise anding. TRUTH_AND_EXPR is for anding two
8604 boolean values when we want in all cases to compute both of them. In
8605 general it is fastest to do TRUTH_AND_EXPR by computing both operands
8606 as actual zero-or-1 values and then bitwise anding. In cases where
8607 there cannot be any side effects, better code would be made by
8608 treating TRUTH_AND_EXPR like TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR; but the question is
8609 how to recognize those cases. */
8611 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
8612 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
8613 this_optab = and_optab;
8614 goto binop;
8616 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
8617 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
8618 this_optab = ior_optab;
8619 goto binop;
8621 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
8622 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
8623 this_optab = xor_optab;
8624 goto binop;
8626 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
8627 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
8628 case LROTATE_EXPR:
8629 case RROTATE_EXPR:
8630 if (! safe_from_p (subtarget, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
8631 subtarget = 0;
8632 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8633 target = 0;
8634 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
8635 return expand_shift (code, mode, op0, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target,
8636 unsignedp);
8638 /* Could determine the answer when only additive constants differ. Also,
8639 the addition of one can be handled by changing the condition. */
8640 case LT_EXPR:
8641 case LE_EXPR:
8642 case GT_EXPR:
8643 case GE_EXPR:
8644 case EQ_EXPR:
8645 case NE_EXPR:
8646 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
8647 case ORDERED_EXPR:
8648 case UNLT_EXPR:
8649 case UNLE_EXPR:
8650 case UNGT_EXPR:
8651 case UNGE_EXPR:
8652 case UNEQ_EXPR:
8653 temp = do_store_flag (exp,
8654 modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? target : NULL_RTX,
8655 tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode, 0);
8656 if (temp != 0)
8657 return temp;
8659 /* For foo != 0, load foo, and if it is nonzero load 1 instead. */
8660 if (code == NE_EXPR && integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
8661 && original_target
8662 && GET_CODE (original_target) == REG
8663 && (GET_MODE (original_target)
8664 == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))))
8666 temp = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), original_target,
8667 VOIDmode, 0);
8669 /* If temp is constant, we can just compute the result. */
8670 if (GET_CODE (temp) == CONST_INT)
8672 if (INTVAL (temp) != 0)
8673 emit_move_insn (target, const1_rtx);
8674 else
8675 emit_move_insn (target, const0_rtx);
8677 return target;
8680 if (temp != original_target)
8682 enum machine_mode mode1 = GET_MODE (temp);
8683 if (mode1 == VOIDmode)
8684 mode1 = tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode;
8686 temp = copy_to_mode_reg (mode1, temp);
8689 op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
8690 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (temp, const0_rtx, EQ, NULL_RTX,
8691 GET_MODE (temp), unsignedp, op1);
8692 emit_move_insn (temp, const1_rtx);
8693 emit_label (op1);
8694 return temp;
8697 /* If no set-flag instruction, must generate a conditional
8698 store into a temporary variable. Drop through
8699 and handle this like && and ||. */
8701 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
8702 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
8703 if (! ignore
8704 && (target == 0
8705 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
8706 || ! safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)
8707 /* Make sure we don't have a hard reg (such as function's return
8708 value) live across basic blocks, if not optimizing. */
8709 || (!optimize && GET_CODE (target) == REG
8710 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)))
8711 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
8713 if (target)
8714 emit_clr_insn (target);
8716 op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
8717 jumpifnot (exp, op1);
8719 if (target)
8720 emit_0_to_1_insn (target);
8722 emit_label (op1);
8723 return ignore ? const0_rtx : target;
8725 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
8726 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8727 target = 0;
8728 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, VOIDmode, 0);
8729 /* The parser is careful to generate TRUTH_NOT_EXPR
8730 only with operands that are always zero or one. */
8731 temp = expand_binop (mode, xor_optab, op0, const1_rtx,
8732 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8733 if (temp == 0)
8734 abort ();
8735 return temp;
8737 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
8738 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, 0);
8739 emit_queue ();
8740 return expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
8741 (ignore ? const0_rtx : target),
8742 VOIDmode, modifier);
8744 case COND_EXPR:
8745 /* If we would have a "singleton" (see below) were it not for a
8746 conversion in each arm, bring that conversion back out. */
8747 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == NOP_EXPR
8748 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2)) == NOP_EXPR
8749 && (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0))
8750 == TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), 0))))
8752 tree iftrue = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0);
8753 tree iffalse = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), 0);
8755 if ((TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (iftrue)) == '2'
8756 && operand_equal_p (iffalse, TREE_OPERAND (iftrue, 0), 0))
8757 || (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (iffalse)) == '2'
8758 && operand_equal_p (iftrue, TREE_OPERAND (iffalse, 0), 0))
8759 || (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (iftrue)) == '1'
8760 && operand_equal_p (iffalse, TREE_OPERAND (iftrue, 0), 0))
8761 || (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (iffalse)) == '1'
8762 && operand_equal_p (iftrue, TREE_OPERAND (iffalse, 0), 0)))
8763 return expand_expr (build1 (NOP_EXPR, type,
8764 build (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (iftrue),
8765 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),
8766 iftrue, iffalse)),
8767 target, tmode, modifier);
8771 /* Note that COND_EXPRs whose type is a structure or union
8772 are required to be constructed to contain assignments of
8773 a temporary variable, so that we can evaluate them here
8774 for side effect only. If type is void, we must do likewise. */
8776 /* If an arm of the branch requires a cleanup,
8777 only that cleanup is performed. */
8779 tree singleton = 0;
8780 tree binary_op = 0, unary_op = 0;
8782 /* If this is (A ? 1 : 0) and A is a condition, just evaluate it and
8783 convert it to our mode, if necessary. */
8784 if (integer_onep (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
8785 && integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2))
8786 && TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) == '<')
8788 if (ignore)
8790 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
8791 modifier);
8792 return const0_rtx;
8795 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8796 target = 0;
8797 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, mode, modifier);
8798 if (GET_MODE (op0) == mode)
8799 return op0;
8801 if (target == 0)
8802 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8803 convert_move (target, op0, unsignedp);
8804 return target;
8807 /* Check for X ? A + B : A. If we have this, we can copy A to the
8808 output and conditionally add B. Similarly for unary operations.
8809 Don't do this if X has side-effects because those side effects
8810 might affect A or B and the "?" operation is a sequence point in
8811 ANSI. (operand_equal_p tests for side effects.) */
8813 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))) == '2'
8814 && operand_equal_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2),
8815 TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0), 0))
8816 singleton = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), binary_op = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
8817 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2))) == '2'
8818 && operand_equal_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
8819 TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), 0), 0))
8820 singleton = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), binary_op = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
8821 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))) == '1'
8822 && operand_equal_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2),
8823 TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0), 0))
8824 singleton = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), unary_op = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
8825 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2))) == '1'
8826 && operand_equal_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
8827 TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), 0), 0))
8828 singleton = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), unary_op = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
8830 /* If we are not to produce a result, we have no target. Otherwise,
8831 if a target was specified use it; it will not be used as an
8832 intermediate target unless it is safe. If no target, use a
8833 temporary. */
8835 if (ignore)
8836 temp = 0;
8837 else if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8838 temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 0, 1);
8839 else if (original_target
8840 && (safe_from_p (original_target, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 1)
8841 || (singleton && GET_CODE (original_target) == REG
8842 && REGNO (original_target) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
8843 && original_target == var_rtx (singleton)))
8844 && GET_MODE (original_target) == mode
8845 #ifdef HAVE_conditional_move
8846 && (! can_conditionally_move_p (mode)
8847 || GET_CODE (original_target) == REG
8848 || TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type))
8849 #endif
8850 && (GET_CODE (original_target) != MEM
8851 || TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)))
8852 temp = original_target;
8853 else if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type))
8854 abort ();
8855 else
8856 temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 0, 1);
8858 /* If we had X ? A + C : A, with C a constant power of 2, and we can
8859 do the test of X as a store-flag operation, do this as
8860 A + ((X != 0) << log C). Similarly for other simple binary
8861 operators. Only do for C == 1 if BRANCH_COST is low. */
8862 if (temp && singleton && binary_op
8863 && (TREE_CODE (binary_op) == PLUS_EXPR
8864 || TREE_CODE (binary_op) == MINUS_EXPR
8865 || TREE_CODE (binary_op) == BIT_IOR_EXPR
8866 || TREE_CODE (binary_op) == BIT_XOR_EXPR)
8867 && (BRANCH_COST >= 3 ? integer_pow2p (TREE_OPERAND (binary_op, 1))
8868 : integer_onep (TREE_OPERAND (binary_op, 1)))
8869 && TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) == '<')
8871 rtx result;
8872 tree cond;
8873 optab boptab = (TREE_CODE (binary_op) == PLUS_EXPR
8874 ? (TYPE_TRAP_SIGNED (TREE_TYPE (binary_op))
8875 ? addv_optab : add_optab)
8876 : TREE_CODE (binary_op) == MINUS_EXPR
8877 ? (TYPE_TRAP_SIGNED (TREE_TYPE (binary_op))
8878 ? subv_optab : sub_optab)
8879 : TREE_CODE (binary_op) == BIT_IOR_EXPR ? ior_optab
8880 : xor_optab);
8882 /* If we had X ? A : A + 1, do this as A + (X == 0). */
8883 if (singleton == TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
8884 cond = invert_truthvalue (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
8885 else
8886 cond = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
8888 result = do_store_flag (cond, (safe_from_p (temp, singleton, 1)
8889 ? temp : NULL_RTX),
8890 mode, BRANCH_COST <= 1);
8892 if (result != 0 && ! integer_onep (TREE_OPERAND (binary_op, 1)))
8893 result = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, mode, result,
8894 build_int_2 (tree_log2
8895 (TREE_OPERAND
8896 (binary_op, 1)),
8898 (safe_from_p (temp, singleton, 1)
8899 ? temp : NULL_RTX), 0);
8901 if (result)
8903 op1 = expand_expr (singleton, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8904 return expand_binop (mode, boptab, op1, result, temp,
8905 unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8909 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
8910 NO_DEFER_POP;
8911 op0 = gen_label_rtx ();
8913 if (singleton && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
8915 if (temp != 0)
8917 /* If the target conflicts with the other operand of the
8918 binary op, we can't use it. Also, we can't use the target
8919 if it is a hard register, because evaluating the condition
8920 might clobber it. */
8921 if ((binary_op
8922 && ! safe_from_p (temp, TREE_OPERAND (binary_op, 1), 1))
8923 || (GET_CODE (temp) == REG
8924 && REGNO (temp) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
8925 temp = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8926 store_expr (singleton, temp,
8927 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? 2 : 0);
8929 else
8930 expand_expr (singleton,
8931 ignore ? const0_rtx : NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8932 if (singleton == TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
8933 jumpif (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), op0);
8934 else
8935 jumpifnot (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), op0);
8937 start_cleanup_deferral ();
8938 if (binary_op && temp == 0)
8939 /* Just touch the other operand. */
8940 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (binary_op, 1),
8941 ignore ? const0_rtx : NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8942 else if (binary_op)
8943 store_expr (build (TREE_CODE (binary_op), type,
8944 make_tree (type, temp),
8945 TREE_OPERAND (binary_op, 1)),
8946 temp, modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? 2 : 0);
8947 else
8948 store_expr (build1 (TREE_CODE (unary_op), type,
8949 make_tree (type, temp)),
8950 temp, modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? 2 : 0);
8951 op1 = op0;
8953 /* Check for A op 0 ? A : FOO and A op 0 ? FOO : A where OP is any
8954 comparison operator. If we have one of these cases, set the
8955 output to A, branch on A (cse will merge these two references),
8956 then set the output to FOO. */
8957 else if (temp
8958 && TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) == '<'
8959 && integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 1))
8960 && operand_equal_p (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0),
8961 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0)
8962 && (! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
8963 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == SAVE_EXPR)
8964 && safe_from_p (temp, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), 1))
8966 if (GET_CODE (temp) == REG
8967 && REGNO (temp) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8968 temp = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8969 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), temp,
8970 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? 2 : 0);
8971 jumpif (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), op0);
8973 start_cleanup_deferral ();
8974 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), temp,
8975 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? 2 : 0);
8976 op1 = op0;
8978 else if (temp
8979 && TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) == '<'
8980 && integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 1))
8981 && operand_equal_p (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0),
8982 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), 0)
8983 && (! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
8984 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2)) == SAVE_EXPR)
8985 && safe_from_p (temp, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
8987 if (GET_CODE (temp) == REG
8988 && REGNO (temp) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8989 temp = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8990 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), temp,
8991 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? 2 : 0);
8992 jumpifnot (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), op0);
8994 start_cleanup_deferral ();
8995 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), temp,
8996 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? 2 : 0);
8997 op1 = op0;
8999 else
9001 op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
9002 jumpifnot (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), op0);
9004 start_cleanup_deferral ();
9006 /* One branch of the cond can be void, if it never returns. For
9007 example A ? throw : E */
9008 if (temp != 0
9009 && TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) != void_type_node)
9010 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), temp,
9011 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? 2 : 0);
9012 else
9013 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
9014 ignore ? const0_rtx : NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
9015 end_cleanup_deferral ();
9016 emit_queue ();
9017 emit_jump_insn (gen_jump (op1));
9018 emit_barrier ();
9019 emit_label (op0);
9020 start_cleanup_deferral ();
9021 if (temp != 0
9022 && TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2)) != void_type_node)
9023 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), temp,
9024 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? 2 : 0);
9025 else
9026 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2),
9027 ignore ? const0_rtx : NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
9030 end_cleanup_deferral ();
9032 emit_queue ();
9033 emit_label (op1);
9034 OK_DEFER_POP;
9036 return temp;
9039 case TARGET_EXPR:
9041 /* Something needs to be initialized, but we didn't know
9042 where that thing was when building the tree. For example,
9043 it could be the return value of a function, or a parameter
9044 to a function which lays down in the stack, or a temporary
9045 variable which must be passed by reference.
9047 We guarantee that the expression will either be constructed
9048 or copied into our original target. */
9050 tree slot = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9051 tree cleanups = NULL_TREE;
9052 tree exp1;
9054 if (TREE_CODE (slot) != VAR_DECL)
9055 abort ();
9057 if (! ignore)
9058 target = original_target;
9060 /* Set this here so that if we get a target that refers to a
9061 register variable that's already been used, put_reg_into_stack
9062 knows that it should fix up those uses. */
9063 TREE_USED (slot) = 1;
9065 if (target == 0)
9067 if (DECL_RTL_SET_P (slot))
9069 target = DECL_RTL (slot);
9070 /* If we have already expanded the slot, so don't do
9071 it again. (mrs) */
9072 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1) == NULL_TREE)
9073 return target;
9075 else
9077 target = assign_temp (type, 2, 0, 1);
9078 /* All temp slots at this level must not conflict. */
9079 preserve_temp_slots (target);
9080 SET_DECL_RTL (slot, target);
9081 if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (slot))
9082 put_var_into_stack (slot, /*rescan=*/false);
9084 /* Since SLOT is not known to the called function
9085 to belong to its stack frame, we must build an explicit
9086 cleanup. This case occurs when we must build up a reference
9087 to pass the reference as an argument. In this case,
9088 it is very likely that such a reference need not be
9089 built here. */
9091 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2) == 0)
9092 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2)
9093 = (*lang_hooks.maybe_build_cleanup) (slot);
9094 cleanups = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
9097 else
9099 /* This case does occur, when expanding a parameter which
9100 needs to be constructed on the stack. The target
9101 is the actual stack address that we want to initialize.
9102 The function we call will perform the cleanup in this case. */
9104 /* If we have already assigned it space, use that space,
9105 not target that we were passed in, as our target
9106 parameter is only a hint. */
9107 if (DECL_RTL_SET_P (slot))
9109 target = DECL_RTL (slot);
9110 /* If we have already expanded the slot, so don't do
9111 it again. (mrs) */
9112 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1) == NULL_TREE)
9113 return target;
9115 else
9117 SET_DECL_RTL (slot, target);
9118 /* If we must have an addressable slot, then make sure that
9119 the RTL that we just stored in slot is OK. */
9120 if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (slot))
9121 put_var_into_stack (slot, /*rescan=*/true);
9125 exp1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 3) = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
9126 /* Mark it as expanded. */
9127 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1) = NULL_TREE;
9129 store_expr (exp1, target, modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? 2 : 0);
9131 expand_decl_cleanup_eh (NULL_TREE, cleanups, CLEANUP_EH_ONLY (exp));
9133 return target;
9136 case INIT_EXPR:
9138 tree lhs = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9139 tree rhs = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
9141 temp = expand_assignment (lhs, rhs, ! ignore);
9142 return temp;
9145 case MODIFY_EXPR:
9147 /* If lhs is complex, expand calls in rhs before computing it.
9148 That's so we don't compute a pointer and save it over a
9149 call. If lhs is simple, compute it first so we can give it
9150 as a target if the rhs is just a call. This avoids an
9151 extra temp and copy and that prevents a partial-subsumption
9152 which makes bad code. Actually we could treat
9153 component_ref's of vars like vars. */
9155 tree lhs = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9156 tree rhs = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
9158 temp = 0;
9160 /* Check for |= or &= of a bitfield of size one into another bitfield
9161 of size 1. In this case, (unless we need the result of the
9162 assignment) we can do this more efficiently with a
9163 test followed by an assignment, if necessary.
9165 ??? At this point, we can't get a BIT_FIELD_REF here. But if
9166 things change so we do, this code should be enhanced to
9167 support it. */
9168 if (ignore
9169 && TREE_CODE (lhs) == COMPONENT_REF
9170 && (TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR
9171 || TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_AND_EXPR)
9172 && TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 0) == lhs
9173 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1)) == COMPONENT_REF
9174 && integer_onep (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (lhs, 1)))
9175 && integer_onep (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1), 1))))
9177 rtx label = gen_label_rtx ();
9179 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1),
9180 TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR ? label : 0,
9181 TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_AND_EXPR ? label : 0);
9182 expand_assignment (lhs, convert (TREE_TYPE (rhs),
9183 (TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR
9184 ? integer_one_node
9185 : integer_zero_node)),
9187 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
9188 emit_label (label);
9189 return const0_rtx;
9192 temp = expand_assignment (lhs, rhs, ! ignore);
9194 return temp;
9197 case RETURN_EXPR:
9198 if (!TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
9199 expand_null_return ();
9200 else
9201 expand_return (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
9202 return const0_rtx;
9204 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
9205 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
9206 return expand_increment (exp, 0, ignore);
9208 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
9209 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
9210 /* Faster to treat as pre-increment if result is not used. */
9211 return expand_increment (exp, ! ignore, ignore);
9213 case ADDR_EXPR:
9214 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9215 target = 0;
9216 /* Are we taking the address of a nested function? */
9217 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == FUNCTION_DECL
9218 && decl_function_context (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) != 0
9219 && ! DECL_NO_STATIC_CHAIN (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
9220 && ! TREE_STATIC (exp))
9222 op0 = trampoline_address (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
9223 op0 = force_operand (op0, target);
9225 /* If we are taking the address of something erroneous, just
9226 return a zero. */
9227 else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ERROR_MARK)
9228 return const0_rtx;
9229 /* If we are taking the address of a constant and are at the
9230 top level, we have to use output_constant_def since we can't
9231 call force_const_mem at top level. */
9232 else if (cfun == 0
9233 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == CONSTRUCTOR
9234 || (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
9235 == 'c')))
9236 op0 = XEXP (output_constant_def (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0), 0);
9237 else
9239 /* We make sure to pass const0_rtx down if we came in with
9240 ignore set, to avoid doing the cleanups twice for something. */
9241 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),
9242 ignore ? const0_rtx : NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
9243 (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9244 ? modifier : EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS));
9246 /* If we are going to ignore the result, OP0 will have been set
9247 to const0_rtx, so just return it. Don't get confused and
9248 think we are taking the address of the constant. */
9249 if (ignore)
9250 return op0;
9252 /* Pass 1 for MODIFY, so that protect_from_queue doesn't get
9253 clever and returns a REG when given a MEM. */
9254 op0 = protect_from_queue (op0, 1);
9256 /* We would like the object in memory. If it is a constant, we can
9257 have it be statically allocated into memory. For a non-constant,
9258 we need to allocate some memory and store the value into it. */
9260 if (CONSTANT_P (op0))
9261 op0 = force_const_mem (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))),
9262 op0);
9263 else if (GET_CODE (op0) == REG || GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG
9264 || GET_CODE (op0) == CONCAT || GET_CODE (op0) == ADDRESSOF
9265 || GET_CODE (op0) == PARALLEL || GET_CODE (op0) == LO_SUM)
9267 /* If the operand is a SAVE_EXPR, we can deal with this by
9268 forcing the SAVE_EXPR into memory. */
9269 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == SAVE_EXPR)
9271 put_var_into_stack (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),
9272 /*rescan=*/true);
9273 op0 = SAVE_EXPR_RTL (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
9275 else
9277 /* If this object is in a register, it can't be BLKmode. */
9278 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
9279 rtx memloc = assign_temp (inner_type, 1, 1, 1);
9281 if (GET_CODE (op0) == PARALLEL)
9282 /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple
9283 non-contiguous locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples
9284 of this. */
9285 emit_group_store (memloc, op0, inner_type,
9286 int_size_in_bytes (inner_type));
9287 else
9288 emit_move_insn (memloc, op0);
9290 op0 = memloc;
9294 if (GET_CODE (op0) != MEM)
9295 abort ();
9297 mark_temp_addr_taken (op0);
9298 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9300 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
9301 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
9302 if (GET_MODE (op0) == Pmode && GET_MODE (op0) != mode
9303 && mode == ptr_mode)
9304 op0 = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, op0);
9305 #endif
9306 return op0;
9309 /* If OP0 is not aligned as least as much as the type requires, we
9310 need to make a temporary, copy OP0 to it, and take the address of
9311 the temporary. We want to use the alignment of the type, not of
9312 the operand. Note that this is incorrect for FUNCTION_TYPE, but
9313 the test for BLKmode means that can't happen. The test for
9314 BLKmode is because we never make mis-aligned MEMs with
9315 non-BLKmode.
9317 We don't need to do this at all if the machine doesn't have
9318 strict alignment. */
9319 if (STRICT_ALIGNMENT && GET_MODE (op0) == BLKmode
9320 && (TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
9321 > MEM_ALIGN (op0))
9322 && MEM_ALIGN (op0) < BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT)
9324 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
9325 rtx new;
9327 if (TYPE_ALIGN_OK (inner_type))
9328 abort ();
9330 if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (inner_type))
9332 /* We can't make a bitwise copy of this object, so fail. */
9333 error ("cannot take the address of an unaligned member");
9334 return const0_rtx;
9337 new = assign_stack_temp_for_type
9338 (TYPE_MODE (inner_type),
9339 MEM_SIZE (op0) ? INTVAL (MEM_SIZE (op0))
9340 : int_size_in_bytes (inner_type),
9341 1, build_qualified_type (inner_type,
9342 (TYPE_QUALS (inner_type)
9343 | TYPE_QUAL_CONST)));
9345 emit_block_move (new, op0, expr_size (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)),
9346 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9347 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
9349 op0 = new;
9352 op0 = force_operand (XEXP (op0, 0), target);
9355 if (flag_force_addr
9356 && GET_CODE (op0) != REG
9357 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9358 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9359 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM)
9360 op0 = force_reg (Pmode, op0);
9362 if (GET_CODE (op0) == REG
9363 && ! REG_USERVAR_P (op0))
9364 mark_reg_pointer (op0, TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (type)));
9366 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
9367 if (GET_MODE (op0) == Pmode && GET_MODE (op0) != mode
9368 && mode == ptr_mode)
9369 op0 = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, op0);
9370 #endif
9372 return op0;
9374 case ENTRY_VALUE_EXPR:
9375 abort ();
9377 /* COMPLEX type for Extended Pascal & Fortran */
9378 case COMPLEX_EXPR:
9380 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
9381 rtx insns;
9383 /* Get the rtx code of the operands. */
9384 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0, VOIDmode, 0);
9385 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0, VOIDmode, 0);
9387 if (! target)
9388 target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
9390 start_sequence ();
9392 /* Move the real (op0) and imaginary (op1) parts to their location. */
9393 emit_move_insn (gen_realpart (mode, target), op0);
9394 emit_move_insn (gen_imagpart (mode, target), op1);
9396 insns = get_insns ();
9397 end_sequence ();
9399 /* Complex construction should appear as a single unit. */
9400 /* If TARGET is a CONCAT, we got insns like RD = RS, ID = IS,
9401 each with a separate pseudo as destination.
9402 It's not correct for flow to treat them as a unit. */
9403 if (GET_CODE (target) != CONCAT)
9404 emit_no_conflict_block (insns, target, op0, op1, NULL_RTX);
9405 else
9406 emit_insn (insns);
9408 return target;
9411 case REALPART_EXPR:
9412 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0, VOIDmode, 0);
9413 return gen_realpart (mode, op0);
9415 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
9416 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0, VOIDmode, 0);
9417 return gen_imagpart (mode, op0);
9419 case CONJ_EXPR:
9421 enum machine_mode partmode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
9422 rtx imag_t;
9423 rtx insns;
9425 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0, VOIDmode, 0);
9427 if (! target)
9428 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
9430 start_sequence ();
9432 /* Store the realpart and the negated imagpart to target. */
9433 emit_move_insn (gen_realpart (partmode, target),
9434 gen_realpart (partmode, op0));
9436 imag_t = gen_imagpart (partmode, target);
9437 temp = expand_unop (partmode,
9438 ! unsignedp && flag_trapv
9439 && (GET_MODE_CLASS(partmode) == MODE_INT)
9440 ? negv_optab : neg_optab,
9441 gen_imagpart (partmode, op0), imag_t, 0);
9442 if (temp != imag_t)
9443 emit_move_insn (imag_t, temp);
9445 insns = get_insns ();
9446 end_sequence ();
9448 /* Conjugate should appear as a single unit
9449 If TARGET is a CONCAT, we got insns like RD = RS, ID = - IS,
9450 each with a separate pseudo as destination.
9451 It's not correct for flow to treat them as a unit. */
9452 if (GET_CODE (target) != CONCAT)
9453 emit_no_conflict_block (insns, target, op0, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
9454 else
9455 emit_insn (insns);
9457 return target;
9460 case TRY_CATCH_EXPR:
9462 tree handler = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
9464 expand_eh_region_start ();
9466 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0, VOIDmode, 0);
9468 expand_eh_region_end_cleanup (handler);
9470 return op0;
9473 case TRY_FINALLY_EXPR:
9475 tree try_block = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9476 tree finally_block = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
9478 if (!optimize || unsafe_for_reeval (finally_block) > 1)
9480 /* In this case, wrapping FINALLY_BLOCK in an UNSAVE_EXPR
9481 is not sufficient, so we cannot expand the block twice.
9482 So we play games with GOTO_SUBROUTINE_EXPR to let us
9483 expand the thing only once. */
9484 /* When not optimizing, we go ahead with this form since
9485 (1) user breakpoints operate more predictably without
9486 code duplication, and
9487 (2) we're not running any of the global optimizers
9488 that would explode in time/space with the highly
9489 connected CFG created by the indirect branching. */
9491 rtx finally_label = gen_label_rtx ();
9492 rtx done_label = gen_label_rtx ();
9493 rtx return_link = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
9494 tree cleanup = build (GOTO_SUBROUTINE_EXPR, void_type_node,
9495 (tree) finally_label, (tree) return_link);
9496 TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (cleanup) = 1;
9498 /* Start a new binding layer that will keep track of all cleanup
9499 actions to be performed. */
9500 expand_start_bindings (2);
9501 target_temp_slot_level = temp_slot_level;
9503 expand_decl_cleanup (NULL_TREE, cleanup);
9504 op0 = expand_expr (try_block, target, tmode, modifier);
9506 preserve_temp_slots (op0);
9507 expand_end_bindings (NULL_TREE, 0, 0);
9508 emit_jump (done_label);
9509 emit_label (finally_label);
9510 expand_expr (finally_block, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, 0);
9511 emit_indirect_jump (return_link);
9512 emit_label (done_label);
9514 else
9516 expand_start_bindings (2);
9517 target_temp_slot_level = temp_slot_level;
9519 expand_decl_cleanup (NULL_TREE, finally_block);
9520 op0 = expand_expr (try_block, target, tmode, modifier);
9522 preserve_temp_slots (op0);
9523 expand_end_bindings (NULL_TREE, 0, 0);
9526 return op0;
9529 case GOTO_SUBROUTINE_EXPR:
9531 rtx subr = (rtx) TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9532 rtx return_link = *(rtx *) &TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
9533 rtx return_address = gen_label_rtx ();
9534 emit_move_insn (return_link,
9535 gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, return_address));
9536 emit_jump (subr);
9537 emit_label (return_address);
9538 return const0_rtx;
9541 case VA_ARG_EXPR:
9542 return expand_builtin_va_arg (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), type);
9544 case EXC_PTR_EXPR:
9545 return get_exception_pointer (cfun);
9547 case FDESC_EXPR:
9548 /* Function descriptors are not valid except for as
9549 initialization constants, and should not be expanded. */
9550 abort ();
9552 default:
9553 return (*lang_hooks.expand_expr) (exp, original_target, tmode, modifier);
9556 /* Here to do an ordinary binary operator, generating an instruction
9557 from the optab already placed in `this_optab'. */
9558 binop:
9559 if (! safe_from_p (subtarget, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
9560 subtarget = 0;
9561 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
9562 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
9563 binop2:
9564 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9565 target = 0;
9566 temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target,
9567 unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
9568 if (temp == 0)
9569 abort ();
9570 return temp;
9573 /* Subroutine of above: returns 1 if OFFSET corresponds to an offset that
9574 when applied to the address of EXP produces an address known to be
9575 aligned more than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
9577 static int
9578 is_aligning_offset (tree offset, tree exp)
9580 /* Strip off any conversions and WITH_RECORD_EXPR nodes. */
9581 while (TREE_CODE (offset) == NON_LVALUE_EXPR
9582 || TREE_CODE (offset) == NOP_EXPR
9583 || TREE_CODE (offset) == CONVERT_EXPR
9584 || TREE_CODE (offset) == WITH_RECORD_EXPR)
9585 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
9587 /* We must now have a BIT_AND_EXPR with a constant that is one less than
9588 power of 2 and which is larger than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
9589 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != BIT_AND_EXPR
9590 || !host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1), 1)
9591 || compare_tree_int (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1), BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT) <= 0
9592 || !exact_log2 (tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1), 1) + 1) < 0)
9593 return 0;
9595 /* Look at the first operand of BIT_AND_EXPR and strip any conversion.
9596 It must be NEGATE_EXPR. Then strip any more conversions. */
9597 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
9598 while (TREE_CODE (offset) == NON_LVALUE_EXPR
9599 || TREE_CODE (offset) == NOP_EXPR
9600 || TREE_CODE (offset) == CONVERT_EXPR)
9601 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
9603 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != NEGATE_EXPR)
9604 return 0;
9606 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
9607 while (TREE_CODE (offset) == NON_LVALUE_EXPR
9608 || TREE_CODE (offset) == NOP_EXPR
9609 || TREE_CODE (offset) == CONVERT_EXPR)
9610 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
9612 /* This must now be the address either of EXP or of a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR
9613 whose type is the same as EXP. */
9614 return (TREE_CODE (offset) == ADDR_EXPR
9615 && (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0) == exp
9616 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0)) == PLACEHOLDER_EXPR
9617 && (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0))
9618 == TREE_TYPE (exp)))));
9621 /* Return the tree node if an ARG corresponds to a string constant or zero
9622 if it doesn't. If we return nonzero, set *PTR_OFFSET to the offset
9623 in bytes within the string that ARG is accessing. The type of the
9624 offset will be `sizetype'. */
9626 tree
9627 string_constant (tree arg, tree *ptr_offset)
9629 STRIP_NOPS (arg);
9631 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == ADDR_EXPR
9632 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == STRING_CST)
9634 *ptr_offset = size_zero_node;
9635 return TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
9637 else if (TREE_CODE (arg) == PLUS_EXPR)
9639 tree arg0 = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
9640 tree arg1 = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 1);
9642 STRIP_NOPS (arg0);
9643 STRIP_NOPS (arg1);
9645 if (TREE_CODE (arg0) == ADDR_EXPR
9646 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0)) == STRING_CST)
9648 *ptr_offset = convert (sizetype, arg1);
9649 return TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0);
9651 else if (TREE_CODE (arg1) == ADDR_EXPR
9652 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0)) == STRING_CST)
9654 *ptr_offset = convert (sizetype, arg0);
9655 return TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0);
9659 return 0;
9662 /* Expand code for a post- or pre- increment or decrement
9663 and return the RTX for the result.
9664 POST is 1 for postinc/decrements and 0 for preinc/decrements. */
9666 static rtx
9667 expand_increment (tree exp, int post, int ignore)
9669 rtx op0, op1;
9670 rtx temp, value;
9671 tree incremented = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9672 optab this_optab = add_optab;
9673 int icode;
9674 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
9675 int op0_is_copy = 0;
9676 int single_insn = 0;
9677 /* 1 means we can't store into OP0 directly,
9678 because it is a subreg narrower than a word,
9679 and we don't dare clobber the rest of the word. */
9680 int bad_subreg = 0;
9682 /* Stabilize any component ref that might need to be
9683 evaluated more than once below. */
9684 if (!post
9685 || TREE_CODE (incremented) == BIT_FIELD_REF
9686 || (TREE_CODE (incremented) == COMPONENT_REF
9687 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (incremented, 0)) != INDIRECT_REF
9688 || DECL_BIT_FIELD (TREE_OPERAND (incremented, 1)))))
9689 incremented = stabilize_reference (incremented);
9690 /* Nested *INCREMENT_EXPRs can happen in C++. We must force innermost
9691 ones into save exprs so that they don't accidentally get evaluated
9692 more than once by the code below. */
9693 if (TREE_CODE (incremented) == PREINCREMENT_EXPR
9694 || TREE_CODE (incremented) == PREDECREMENT_EXPR)
9695 incremented = save_expr (incremented);
9697 /* Compute the operands as RTX.
9698 Note whether OP0 is the actual lvalue or a copy of it:
9699 I believe it is a copy iff it is a register or subreg
9700 and insns were generated in computing it. */
9702 temp = get_last_insn ();
9703 op0 = expand_expr (incremented, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
9705 /* If OP0 is a SUBREG made for a promoted variable, we cannot increment
9706 in place but instead must do sign- or zero-extension during assignment,
9707 so we copy it into a new register and let the code below use it as
9708 a copy.
9710 Note that we can safely modify this SUBREG since it is know not to be
9711 shared (it was made by the expand_expr call above). */
9713 if (GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (op0))
9715 if (post)
9716 SUBREG_REG (op0) = copy_to_reg (SUBREG_REG (op0));
9717 else
9718 bad_subreg = 1;
9720 else if (GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG
9721 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)) < BITS_PER_WORD)
9723 /* We cannot increment this SUBREG in place. If we are
9724 post-incrementing, get a copy of the old value. Otherwise,
9725 just mark that we cannot increment in place. */
9726 if (post)
9727 op0 = copy_to_reg (op0);
9728 else
9729 bad_subreg = 1;
9732 op0_is_copy = ((GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG || GET_CODE (op0) == REG)
9733 && temp != get_last_insn ());
9734 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
9736 /* Decide whether incrementing or decrementing. */
9737 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == POSTDECREMENT_EXPR
9738 || TREE_CODE (exp) == PREDECREMENT_EXPR)
9739 this_optab = sub_optab;
9741 /* Convert decrement by a constant into a negative increment. */
9742 if (this_optab == sub_optab
9743 && GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT)
9745 op1 = GEN_INT (-INTVAL (op1));
9746 this_optab = add_optab;
9749 if (TYPE_TRAP_SIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
9750 this_optab = this_optab == add_optab ? addv_optab : subv_optab;
9752 /* For a preincrement, see if we can do this with a single instruction. */
9753 if (!post)
9755 icode = (int) this_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code;
9756 if (icode != (int) CODE_FOR_nothing
9757 /* Make sure that OP0 is valid for operands 0 and 1
9758 of the insn we want to queue. */
9759 && (*insn_data[icode].operand[0].predicate) (op0, mode)
9760 && (*insn_data[icode].operand[1].predicate) (op0, mode)
9761 && (*insn_data[icode].operand[2].predicate) (op1, mode))
9762 single_insn = 1;
9765 /* If OP0 is not the actual lvalue, but rather a copy in a register,
9766 then we cannot just increment OP0. We must therefore contrive to
9767 increment the original value. Then, for postincrement, we can return
9768 OP0 since it is a copy of the old value. For preincrement, expand here
9769 unless we can do it with a single insn.
9771 Likewise if storing directly into OP0 would clobber high bits
9772 we need to preserve (bad_subreg). */
9773 if (op0_is_copy || (!post && !single_insn) || bad_subreg)
9775 /* This is the easiest way to increment the value wherever it is.
9776 Problems with multiple evaluation of INCREMENTED are prevented
9777 because either (1) it is a component_ref or preincrement,
9778 in which case it was stabilized above, or (2) it is an array_ref
9779 with constant index in an array in a register, which is
9780 safe to reevaluate. */
9781 tree newexp = build (((TREE_CODE (exp) == POSTDECREMENT_EXPR
9782 || TREE_CODE (exp) == PREDECREMENT_EXPR)
9783 ? MINUS_EXPR : PLUS_EXPR),
9784 TREE_TYPE (exp),
9785 incremented,
9786 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
9788 while (TREE_CODE (incremented) == NOP_EXPR
9789 || TREE_CODE (incremented) == CONVERT_EXPR)
9791 newexp = convert (TREE_TYPE (incremented), newexp);
9792 incremented = TREE_OPERAND (incremented, 0);
9795 temp = expand_assignment (incremented, newexp, ! post && ! ignore);
9796 return post ? op0 : temp;
9799 if (post)
9801 /* We have a true reference to the value in OP0.
9802 If there is an insn to add or subtract in this mode, queue it.
9803 Queueing the increment insn avoids the register shuffling
9804 that often results if we must increment now and first save
9805 the old value for subsequent use. */
9807 #if 0 /* Turned off to avoid making extra insn for indexed memref. */
9808 op0 = stabilize (op0);
9809 #endif
9811 icode = (int) this_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code;
9812 if (icode != (int) CODE_FOR_nothing
9813 /* Make sure that OP0 is valid for operands 0 and 1
9814 of the insn we want to queue. */
9815 && (*insn_data[icode].operand[0].predicate) (op0, mode)
9816 && (*insn_data[icode].operand[1].predicate) (op0, mode))
9818 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[2].predicate) (op1, mode))
9819 op1 = force_reg (mode, op1);
9821 return enqueue_insn (op0, GEN_FCN (icode) (op0, op0, op1));
9823 if (icode != (int) CODE_FOR_nothing && GET_CODE (op0) == MEM)
9825 rtx addr = (general_operand (XEXP (op0, 0), mode)
9826 ? force_reg (Pmode, XEXP (op0, 0))
9827 : copy_to_reg (XEXP (op0, 0)));
9828 rtx temp, result;
9830 op0 = replace_equiv_address (op0, addr);
9831 temp = force_reg (GET_MODE (op0), op0);
9832 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[2].predicate) (op1, mode))
9833 op1 = force_reg (mode, op1);
9835 /* The increment queue is LIFO, thus we have to `queue'
9836 the instructions in reverse order. */
9837 enqueue_insn (op0, gen_move_insn (op0, temp));
9838 result = enqueue_insn (temp, GEN_FCN (icode) (temp, temp, op1));
9839 return result;
9843 /* Preincrement, or we can't increment with one simple insn. */
9844 if (post)
9845 /* Save a copy of the value before inc or dec, to return it later. */
9846 temp = value = copy_to_reg (op0);
9847 else
9848 /* Arrange to return the incremented value. */
9849 /* Copy the rtx because expand_binop will protect from the queue,
9850 and the results of that would be invalid for us to return
9851 if our caller does emit_queue before using our result. */
9852 temp = copy_rtx (value = op0);
9854 /* Increment however we can. */
9855 op1 = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, value, op1, op0,
9856 TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)), OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
9858 /* Make sure the value is stored into OP0. */
9859 if (op1 != op0)
9860 emit_move_insn (op0, op1);
9862 return temp;
9865 /* Generate code to calculate EXP using a store-flag instruction
9866 and return an rtx for the result. EXP is either a comparison
9867 or a TRUTH_NOT_EXPR whose operand is a comparison.
9869 If TARGET is nonzero, store the result there if convenient.
9871 If ONLY_CHEAP is nonzero, only do this if it is likely to be very
9872 cheap.
9874 Return zero if there is no suitable set-flag instruction
9875 available on this machine.
9877 Once expand_expr has been called on the arguments of the comparison,
9878 we are committed to doing the store flag, since it is not safe to
9879 re-evaluate the expression. We emit the store-flag insn by calling
9880 emit_store_flag, but only expand the arguments if we have a reason
9881 to believe that emit_store_flag will be successful. If we think that
9882 it will, but it isn't, we have to simulate the store-flag with a
9883 set/jump/set sequence. */
9885 static rtx
9886 do_store_flag (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode mode, int only_cheap)
9888 enum rtx_code code;
9889 tree arg0, arg1, type;
9890 tree tem;
9891 enum machine_mode operand_mode;
9892 int invert = 0;
9893 int unsignedp;
9894 rtx op0, op1;
9895 enum insn_code icode;
9896 rtx subtarget = target;
9897 rtx result, label;
9899 /* If this is a TRUTH_NOT_EXPR, set a flag indicating we must invert the
9900 result at the end. We can't simply invert the test since it would
9901 have already been inverted if it were valid. This case occurs for
9902 some floating-point comparisons. */
9904 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == TRUTH_NOT_EXPR)
9905 invert = 1, exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9907 arg0 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9908 arg1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
9910 /* Don't crash if the comparison was erroneous. */
9911 if (arg0 == error_mark_node || arg1 == error_mark_node)
9912 return const0_rtx;
9914 type = TREE_TYPE (arg0);
9915 operand_mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
9916 unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (type);
9918 /* We won't bother with BLKmode store-flag operations because it would mean
9919 passing a lot of information to emit_store_flag. */
9920 if (operand_mode == BLKmode)
9921 return 0;
9923 /* We won't bother with store-flag operations involving function pointers
9924 when function pointers must be canonicalized before comparisons. */
9925 #ifdef HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare
9926 if (HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare
9927 && ((TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) == POINTER_TYPE
9928 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))
9929 == FUNCTION_TYPE))
9930 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))) == POINTER_TYPE
9931 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))))
9932 == FUNCTION_TYPE))))
9933 return 0;
9934 #endif
9936 STRIP_NOPS (arg0);
9937 STRIP_NOPS (arg1);
9939 /* Get the rtx comparison code to use. We know that EXP is a comparison
9940 operation of some type. Some comparisons against 1 and -1 can be
9941 converted to comparisons with zero. Do so here so that the tests
9942 below will be aware that we have a comparison with zero. These
9943 tests will not catch constants in the first operand, but constants
9944 are rarely passed as the first operand. */
9946 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
9948 case EQ_EXPR:
9949 code = EQ;
9950 break;
9951 case NE_EXPR:
9952 code = NE;
9953 break;
9954 case LT_EXPR:
9955 if (integer_onep (arg1))
9956 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
9957 else
9958 code = unsignedp ? LTU : LT;
9959 break;
9960 case LE_EXPR:
9961 if (! unsignedp && integer_all_onesp (arg1))
9962 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = LT;
9963 else
9964 code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
9965 break;
9966 case GT_EXPR:
9967 if (! unsignedp && integer_all_onesp (arg1))
9968 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = GE;
9969 else
9970 code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
9971 break;
9972 case GE_EXPR:
9973 if (integer_onep (arg1))
9974 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
9975 else
9976 code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
9977 break;
9979 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
9980 code = UNORDERED;
9981 break;
9982 case ORDERED_EXPR:
9983 code = ORDERED;
9984 break;
9985 case UNLT_EXPR:
9986 code = UNLT;
9987 break;
9988 case UNLE_EXPR:
9989 code = UNLE;
9990 break;
9991 case UNGT_EXPR:
9992 code = UNGT;
9993 break;
9994 case UNGE_EXPR:
9995 code = UNGE;
9996 break;
9997 case UNEQ_EXPR:
9998 code = UNEQ;
9999 break;
10001 default:
10002 abort ();
10005 /* Put a constant second. */
10006 if (TREE_CODE (arg0) == REAL_CST || TREE_CODE (arg0) == INTEGER_CST)
10008 tem = arg0; arg0 = arg1; arg1 = tem;
10009 code = swap_condition (code);
10012 /* If this is an equality or inequality test of a single bit, we can
10013 do this by shifting the bit being tested to the low-order bit and
10014 masking the result with the constant 1. If the condition was EQ,
10015 we xor it with 1. This does not require an scc insn and is faster
10016 than an scc insn even if we have it.
10018 The code to make this transformation was moved into fold_single_bit_test,
10019 so we just call into the folder and expand its result. */
10021 if ((code == NE || code == EQ)
10022 && TREE_CODE (arg0) == BIT_AND_EXPR && integer_zerop (arg1)
10023 && integer_pow2p (TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 1)))
10025 tree type = (*lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode) (mode, unsignedp);
10026 return expand_expr (fold_single_bit_test (code == NE ? NE_EXPR : EQ_EXPR,
10027 arg0, arg1, type),
10028 target, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10031 /* Now see if we are likely to be able to do this. Return if not. */
10032 if (! can_compare_p (code, operand_mode, ccp_store_flag))
10033 return 0;
10035 icode = setcc_gen_code[(int) code];
10036 if (icode == CODE_FOR_nothing
10037 || (only_cheap && insn_data[(int) icode].operand[0].mode != mode))
10039 /* We can only do this if it is one of the special cases that
10040 can be handled without an scc insn. */
10041 if ((code == LT && integer_zerop (arg1))
10042 || (! only_cheap && code == GE && integer_zerop (arg1)))
10044 else if (BRANCH_COST >= 0
10045 && ! only_cheap && (code == NE || code == EQ)
10046 && TREE_CODE (type) != REAL_TYPE
10047 && ((abs_optab->handlers[(int) operand_mode].insn_code
10048 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
10049 || (ffs_optab->handlers[(int) operand_mode].insn_code
10050 != CODE_FOR_nothing)))
10052 else
10053 return 0;
10056 if (! get_subtarget (target)
10057 || GET_MODE (subtarget) != operand_mode
10058 || ! safe_from_p (subtarget, arg1, 1))
10059 subtarget = 0;
10061 op0 = expand_expr (arg0, subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
10062 op1 = expand_expr (arg1, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
10064 if (target == 0)
10065 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
10067 /* Pass copies of OP0 and OP1 in case they contain a QUEUED. This is safe
10068 because, if the emit_store_flag does anything it will succeed and
10069 OP0 and OP1 will not be used subsequently. */
10071 result = emit_store_flag (target, code,
10072 queued_subexp_p (op0) ? copy_rtx (op0) : op0,
10073 queued_subexp_p (op1) ? copy_rtx (op1) : op1,
10074 operand_mode, unsignedp, 1);
10076 if (result)
10078 if (invert)
10079 result = expand_binop (mode, xor_optab, result, const1_rtx,
10080 result, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
10081 return result;
10084 /* If this failed, we have to do this with set/compare/jump/set code. */
10085 if (GET_CODE (target) != REG
10086 || reg_mentioned_p (target, op0) || reg_mentioned_p (target, op1))
10087 target = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (target));
10089 emit_move_insn (target, invert ? const0_rtx : const1_rtx);
10090 result = compare_from_rtx (op0, op1, code, unsignedp,
10091 operand_mode, NULL_RTX);
10092 if (GET_CODE (result) == CONST_INT)
10093 return (((result == const0_rtx && ! invert)
10094 || (result != const0_rtx && invert))
10095 ? const0_rtx : const1_rtx);
10097 /* The code of RESULT may not match CODE if compare_from_rtx
10098 decided to swap its operands and reverse the original code.
10100 We know that compare_from_rtx returns either a CONST_INT or
10101 a new comparison code, so it is safe to just extract the
10102 code from RESULT. */
10103 code = GET_CODE (result);
10105 label = gen_label_rtx ();
10106 if (bcc_gen_fctn[(int) code] == 0)
10107 abort ();
10109 emit_jump_insn ((*bcc_gen_fctn[(int) code]) (label));
10110 emit_move_insn (target, invert ? const1_rtx : const0_rtx);
10111 emit_label (label);
10113 return target;
10117 /* Stubs in case we haven't got a casesi insn. */
10118 #ifndef HAVE_casesi
10119 # define HAVE_casesi 0
10120 # define gen_casesi(a, b, c, d, e) (0)
10121 # define CODE_FOR_casesi CODE_FOR_nothing
10122 #endif
10124 /* If the machine does not have a case insn that compares the bounds,
10125 this means extra overhead for dispatch tables, which raises the
10126 threshold for using them. */
10127 #ifndef CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
10128 #define CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (HAVE_casesi ? 4 : 5)
10129 #endif /* CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD */
10131 unsigned int
10132 case_values_threshold (void)
10134 return CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD;
10137 /* Attempt to generate a casesi instruction. Returns 1 if successful,
10138 0 otherwise (i.e. if there is no casesi instruction). */
10140 try_casesi (tree index_type, tree index_expr, tree minval, tree range,
10141 rtx table_label ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, rtx default_label)
10143 enum machine_mode index_mode = SImode;
10144 int index_bits = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (index_mode);
10145 rtx op1, op2, index;
10146 enum machine_mode op_mode;
10148 if (! HAVE_casesi)
10149 return 0;
10151 /* Convert the index to SImode. */
10152 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (index_type)) > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (index_mode))
10154 enum machine_mode omode = TYPE_MODE (index_type);
10155 rtx rangertx = expand_expr (range, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
10157 /* We must handle the endpoints in the original mode. */
10158 index_expr = build (MINUS_EXPR, index_type,
10159 index_expr, minval);
10160 minval = integer_zero_node;
10161 index = expand_expr (index_expr, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
10162 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (rangertx, index, LTU, NULL_RTX,
10163 omode, 1, default_label);
10164 /* Now we can safely truncate. */
10165 index = convert_to_mode (index_mode, index, 0);
10167 else
10169 if (TYPE_MODE (index_type) != index_mode)
10171 index_expr = convert ((*lang_hooks.types.type_for_size)
10172 (index_bits, 0), index_expr);
10173 index_type = TREE_TYPE (index_expr);
10176 index = expand_expr (index_expr, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
10178 emit_queue ();
10179 index = protect_from_queue (index, 0);
10180 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
10182 op_mode = insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[0].mode;
10183 if (! (*insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[0].predicate)
10184 (index, op_mode))
10185 index = copy_to_mode_reg (op_mode, index);
10187 op1 = expand_expr (minval, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
10189 op_mode = insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[1].mode;
10190 op1 = convert_modes (op_mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (minval)),
10191 op1, TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (minval)));
10192 if (! (*insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[1].predicate)
10193 (op1, op_mode))
10194 op1 = copy_to_mode_reg (op_mode, op1);
10196 op2 = expand_expr (range, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
10198 op_mode = insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[2].mode;
10199 op2 = convert_modes (op_mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (range)),
10200 op2, TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (range)));
10201 if (! (*insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[2].predicate)
10202 (op2, op_mode))
10203 op2 = copy_to_mode_reg (op_mode, op2);
10205 emit_jump_insn (gen_casesi (index, op1, op2,
10206 table_label, default_label));
10207 return 1;
10210 /* Attempt to generate a tablejump instruction; same concept. */
10211 #ifndef HAVE_tablejump
10212 #define HAVE_tablejump 0
10213 #define gen_tablejump(x, y) (0)
10214 #endif
10216 /* Subroutine of the next function.
10218 INDEX is the value being switched on, with the lowest value
10219 in the table already subtracted.
10220 MODE is its expected mode (needed if INDEX is constant).
10221 RANGE is the length of the jump table.
10222 TABLE_LABEL is a CODE_LABEL rtx for the table itself.
10224 DEFAULT_LABEL is a CODE_LABEL rtx to jump to if the
10225 index value is out of range. */
10227 static void
10228 do_tablejump (rtx index, enum machine_mode mode, rtx range, rtx table_label,
10229 rtx default_label)
10231 rtx temp, vector;
10233 if (INTVAL (range) > cfun->max_jumptable_ents)
10234 cfun->max_jumptable_ents = INTVAL (range);
10236 /* Do an unsigned comparison (in the proper mode) between the index
10237 expression and the value which represents the length of the range.
10238 Since we just finished subtracting the lower bound of the range
10239 from the index expression, this comparison allows us to simultaneously
10240 check that the original index expression value is both greater than
10241 or equal to the minimum value of the range and less than or equal to
10242 the maximum value of the range. */
10244 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (index, range, GTU, NULL_RTX, mode, 1,
10245 default_label);
10247 /* If index is in range, it must fit in Pmode.
10248 Convert to Pmode so we can index with it. */
10249 if (mode != Pmode)
10250 index = convert_to_mode (Pmode, index, 1);
10252 /* Don't let a MEM slip thru, because then INDEX that comes
10253 out of PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS won't be a valid address,
10254 and break_out_memory_refs will go to work on it and mess it up. */
10255 #ifdef PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS
10256 if (flag_pic && GET_CODE (index) != REG)
10257 index = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, index);
10258 #endif
10260 /* If flag_force_addr were to affect this address
10261 it could interfere with the tricky assumptions made
10262 about addresses that contain label-refs,
10263 which may be valid only very near the tablejump itself. */
10264 /* ??? The only correct use of CASE_VECTOR_MODE is the one inside the
10265 GET_MODE_SIZE, because this indicates how large insns are. The other
10266 uses should all be Pmode, because they are addresses. This code
10267 could fail if addresses and insns are not the same size. */
10268 index = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
10269 gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode, index,
10270 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (CASE_VECTOR_MODE))),
10271 gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, table_label));
10272 #ifdef PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS
10273 if (flag_pic)
10274 index = PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS (index);
10275 else
10276 #endif
10277 index = memory_address_noforce (CASE_VECTOR_MODE, index);
10278 temp = gen_reg_rtx (CASE_VECTOR_MODE);
10279 vector = gen_rtx_MEM (CASE_VECTOR_MODE, index);
10280 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (vector) = 1;
10281 MEM_NOTRAP_P (vector) = 1;
10282 convert_move (temp, vector, 0);
10284 emit_jump_insn (gen_tablejump (temp, table_label));
10286 /* If we are generating PIC code or if the table is PC-relative, the
10287 table and JUMP_INSN must be adjacent, so don't output a BARRIER. */
10288 if (! CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE && ! flag_pic)
10289 emit_barrier ();
10293 try_tablejump (tree index_type, tree index_expr, tree minval, tree range,
10294 rtx table_label, rtx default_label)
10296 rtx index;
10298 if (! HAVE_tablejump)
10299 return 0;
10301 index_expr = fold (build (MINUS_EXPR, index_type,
10302 convert (index_type, index_expr),
10303 convert (index_type, minval)));
10304 index = expand_expr (index_expr, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
10305 emit_queue ();
10306 index = protect_from_queue (index, 0);
10307 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
10309 do_tablejump (index, TYPE_MODE (index_type),
10310 convert_modes (TYPE_MODE (index_type),
10311 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (range)),
10312 expand_expr (range, NULL_RTX,
10313 VOIDmode, 0),
10314 TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (range))),
10315 table_label, default_label);
10316 return 1;
10319 /* Nonzero if the mode is a valid vector mode for this architecture.
10320 This returns nonzero even if there is no hardware support for the
10321 vector mode, but we can emulate with narrower modes. */
10324 vector_mode_valid_p (enum machine_mode mode)
10326 enum mode_class class = GET_MODE_CLASS (mode);
10327 enum machine_mode innermode;
10329 /* Doh! What's going on? */
10330 if (class != MODE_VECTOR_INT
10331 && class != MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT)
10332 return 0;
10334 /* Hardware support. Woo hoo! */
10335 if (VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (mode))
10336 return 1;
10338 innermode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
10340 /* We should probably return 1 if requesting V4DI and we have no DI,
10341 but we have V2DI, but this is probably very unlikely. */
10343 /* If we have support for the inner mode, we can safely emulate it.
10344 We may not have V2DI, but me can emulate with a pair of DIs. */
10345 return mov_optab->handlers[innermode].insn_code != CODE_FOR_nothing;
10348 /* Return a CONST_VECTOR rtx for a VECTOR_CST tree. */
10349 static rtx
10350 const_vector_from_tree (tree exp)
10352 rtvec v;
10353 int units, i;
10354 tree link, elt;
10355 enum machine_mode inner, mode;
10357 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
10359 if (is_zeros_p (exp))
10360 return CONST0_RTX (mode);
10362 units = GET_MODE_NUNITS (mode);
10363 inner = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
10365 v = rtvec_alloc (units);
10367 link = TREE_VECTOR_CST_ELTS (exp);
10368 for (i = 0; link; link = TREE_CHAIN (link), ++i)
10370 elt = TREE_VALUE (link);
10372 if (TREE_CODE (elt) == REAL_CST)
10373 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (TREE_REAL_CST (elt),
10374 inner);
10375 else
10376 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (elt),
10377 TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (elt),
10378 inner);
10381 /* Initialize remaining elements to 0. */
10382 for (; i < units; ++i)
10383 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = CONST0_RTX (inner);
10385 return gen_rtx_raw_CONST_VECTOR (mode, v);
10388 #include "gt-expr.h"